f51ff24421e8eba00dd34787fa1bbb39228d40f4
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @end itemize
491
492 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
493 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
494 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
495 @itemize @bullet
496 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
497 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
498 @end itemize
499
500 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
501 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
502 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
503 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
504
505 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
506 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
507 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
508
509 @section USB Other
510 @itemize @bullet
511 @item @b{USBprog}
512 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
513
514 @item @b{USB - Presto}
515 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
516
517 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
518 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
519
520 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
522
523 @item @b{Buspirate}
524 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
525
526 @item @b{opendous}
527 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
528
529 @item @b{estick}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
531
532 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
533 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
534 @end itemize
535
536 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
537
538 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
539 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
540 these on the market.
541
542 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
543 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
544 of USB-based ones.
545
546 @itemize @bullet
547
548 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
549 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
550
551 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
552 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
553 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
554
555 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
556 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
557
558 @item @b{Wiggler2}
559 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
560
561 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
562 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
563
564 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
565 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
566
567 @item @b{arm-jtag}
568 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
569
570 @item @b{chameleon}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Triton}
574 @* Unknown.
575
576 @item @b{Lattice}
577 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
578 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
579
580 @item @b{flashlink}
581 @* From ST Microsystems;
582 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
583
584 @end itemize
585
586 @section Other...
587 @itemize @bullet
588
589 @item @b{ep93xx}
590 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
591
592 @item @b{at91rm9200}
593 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
594
595 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
596 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
597
598 @item @b{imx_gpio}
599 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
600
601 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
602 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
603 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
604
605 @end itemize
606
607 @node About Jim-Tcl
608 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
609 @cindex Jim-Tcl
610 @cindex tcl
611
612 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
613 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
614 command interpreter.
615
616 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
617 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
618 much of anything about Tcl.
619 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
620
621 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
622 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
623 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
624 OpenOCD mailing list.
625
626 @itemize @bullet
627 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
628 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
629 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
630 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
631 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
632 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
633
634 @item @b{Missing Features}
635 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
636 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
637 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
638 enabled in OpenOCD.
639
640 @item @b{Scripts}
641 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
642 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
643 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
644
645 @item @b{Commands}
646 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
647 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
648 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
649 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
650
651 @item @b{Historical Note}
652 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
653 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
654 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
655 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
656
657 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
658 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
659 @end itemize
660
661 @node Running
662 @chapter Running
663 @cindex command line options
664 @cindex logfile
665 @cindex directory search
666
667 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
668 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
669 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
670 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
671 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
672 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
673 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
674
675 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
676 tell it how each debug session should work.
677 The @option{--help} option shows:
678 @verbatim
679 bash$ openocd --help
680
681 --help | -h display this help
682 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
683 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
684 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
685 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
686 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
687 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
688 --command | -c run <command>
689 @end verbatim
690
691 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
692 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
693 To specify one or more different
694 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
695
696 @example
697 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
698 @end example
699
700 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
701 @enumerate
702 @item the current directory,
703 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
704 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
705 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
706 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
707 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
708 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
709 @end enumerate
710 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
711
712 @quotation Note
713 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
714 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
715 @end quotation
716
717 @section Simple setup, no customization
718
719 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
720 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
721 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
722 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
723 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
724
725 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
726 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
727 the server with some variation of one of the following:
728
729 @example
730 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
731 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
732 @end example
733
734 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
735 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
736 If all goes well you'll see output something like
737
738 @example
739 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
740 For bug reports, read
741 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
742 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
743 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
744 @end example
745
746 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
747 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
748 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
749
750 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
751
752 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
753 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
754 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
755 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
756 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
757 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
758 ensure that this always succeeds.
759 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
760 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
761 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
762 and then shut down without acting as a server.
763
764 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
765 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
766 those channels.
767
768 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
769 the @option{-d} option.
770
771 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
772 @option{-c} command line switch.
773
774 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
775 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
776 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
777 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
778 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
779 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
780 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
781
782 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
783 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
784
785 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
786 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
787 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
788 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
789
790 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
791 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
792
793 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
794 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
795 and start the OpenOCD server.
796 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
797 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
798 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
799 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
800
801 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
802
803 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
804 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
805 and a USB cable on the other.
806 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
807 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
808
809 @enumerate
810 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
811 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
812 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
813 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
814 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
815 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
816 debugging host.
817
818 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
819 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
820 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
821 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
822 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
823
824 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
825 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
826 with 1.2 Volt boards.
827
828 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
829 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
830 ways to connect the cable.
831 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
832 Be sure it's firmly connected.
833
834 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
835 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
836 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
837 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
838 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
839 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
840 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
841 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
842
843 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
844 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
845 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
846 but are tedious to set up.
847 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
848 adapter signals to the right board pins.
849
850 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
851 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
852 you are using to run OpenOCD.
853 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
854
855 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
856 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
857 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
858 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
859
860 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
861 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
862 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
863
864 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
865 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
866 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
867 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
868
869 @end enumerate
870
871 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
872 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
873 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
874
875 @section Project Directory
876
877 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
878
879 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
880 single directory for your work with a given board.
881 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
882 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
883 files accessed through semihosting,
884 and for code you upload to the target board.
885 It is also the natural place to write files,
886 such as log files and data you download from the board.
887
888 @section Configuration Basics
889
890 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
891 a variety of ways you can mix them.
892 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
893
894 @itemize
895 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
896 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
897 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
898 @end itemize
899
900 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
901 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
902 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
903
904 @example
905 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
906
907 # GDB can also flash my flash!
908 gdb_memory_map enable
909 gdb_flash_program enable
910
911 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
912 @end example
913
914 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
915
916 @example
917 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
918 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
919 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
920 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
921 @end example
922
923 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
924 each supporting a different development task.
925 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
926 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
927
928 @quotation Important
929 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
930 problems with how it treats variables.
931 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
932 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
933 that can be tested in a later script.
934 @end quotation
935
936 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
937 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
938 to simplify your work.
939
940 @section User Config Files
941 @cindex config file, user
942 @cindex user config file
943 @cindex config file, overview
944
945 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
946 in one place.
947 One of the following will match your situation best:
948
949 @itemize
950 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
951 provided by someone else.
952 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
953 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
954 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
955 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
956 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
957 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
958
959 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
960 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
961
962 @enumerate
963 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
964 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
965 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
966 @end enumerate
967
968 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
969 The first is an interface config file.
970 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
971 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
972 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
973 meet your deadline:
974
975 @example
976 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
977 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
978 @end example
979
980 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
981 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
982 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
983 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
984
985 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
986 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
987 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
988 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
989 target and board
990 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
991 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
992
993 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
994 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
995 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
996 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
997
998 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
999 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1000 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1001 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1002 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1003
1004 @quotation Note
1005 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1006 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1007 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1008 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1009 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1010 @end quotation
1011
1012 @item
1013 You may may need to write some C code.
1014 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1015 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1016 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1017 a new chip architecture.
1018 @end itemize
1019
1020 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1021 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1022 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1023
1024 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1025 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1026 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1027 @itemize
1028
1029 @item
1030 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1031 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1032 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1033 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1034
1035 @item
1036 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1037 @cindex vector_catch
1038 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1039 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1040 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1041 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1042 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1043 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1044
1045 @item
1046 You might need to override some defaults.
1047 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1048 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1049
1050 @item
1051 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1052 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1053 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1054 @end itemize
1055
1056 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1057
1058 A few project-specific utility
1059 routines may well speed up your work.
1060 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1061
1062 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1063 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1064 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1065 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1066 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1067 may help:
1068
1069 @example
1070 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1071 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1072 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1073 # Leave the CPU halted.
1074 reset init
1075
1076 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1077 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1078
1079 # Start running.
1080 resume 0x20000000
1081 @}
1082 @end example
1083
1084 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1085 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1086 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1087 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1088 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1089
1090 @example
1091 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1092 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1093 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1094 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1095 reset init
1096
1097 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1098 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1099 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1100 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1101 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1102 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1103 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1104
1105 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1106 reset run
1107 @}
1108 @end example
1109
1110 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1111 from NAND.
1112 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1113 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1114 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1115
1116 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1117 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1118
1119 @section Target Software Changes
1120
1121 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1122 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1123 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1124 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1125 handling issues like:
1126
1127 @itemize @bullet
1128
1129 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1130 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1131 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1132 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1133 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1134 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1135 your debug sessions.
1136
1137 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1138 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1139 That might however be your only option.
1140
1141 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1142 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1143 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1144 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1145 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1146 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1147 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1148 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1149 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1150 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1151 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1152 instead of the whole thing.
1153 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1154 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1155
1156 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1157 @cindex ARM semihosting
1158 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1159 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1160 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1161 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1162 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1163 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1164 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1165 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1166 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1167 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1168 NAND or SPI flash.
1169
1170 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1171 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1172 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1173 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1174 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1175
1176 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1177 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1178 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1179 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1180 registers which can be used to change various features including
1181 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1182 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1183 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1184 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1185 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1186
1187 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1188 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1189 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1190 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1191 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1192
1193 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1194 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1195 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1196 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1197 early code execution can be debugged
1198 or firmware can be replaced.
1199
1200 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1201 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1202 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1203 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1204 operations like writing to memory.)
1205
1206 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1207 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1208 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1209 various kinds of message.
1210 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1211
1212 @end itemize
1213
1214 @section Target Hardware Setup
1215
1216 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1217 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1218 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1219 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1220 working with.}
1221
1222 Common issues include:
1223
1224 @itemize @bullet
1225
1226 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1227 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1228 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1229 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1230 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1231 or one from a daughtercard).
1232 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1233 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1234
1235 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1236 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1237 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1238 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1239 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1240 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1241
1242 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1243 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1244 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1245 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1246 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1247
1248
1249 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1250 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1251 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1252 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1253 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1254 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1255 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1256
1257 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1258 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1259 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1260 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1261 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1262
1263 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1264 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1265 used to start booting.
1266
1267 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1268 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1269 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1270 multiple audio codec chips).
1271 This interacts with software
1272 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1273 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1274 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1275 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1276 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1277 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1278 audio or video codecs are used.
1279
1280 @end itemize
1281
1282 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1283 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1284 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1285 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1286 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1287 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1288 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1289 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1290 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1291 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1292
1293
1294 @node Config File Guidelines
1295 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1296
1297 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1298 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1299 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1300 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1301
1302 You should find the following directories under
1303 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1304 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1305 @itemize @bullet
1306 @item @file{interface} ...
1307 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1308 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1309 @item @file{board} ...
1310 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1311 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1312
1313 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1314 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1315 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1316 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1317 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1318 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1319 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1320 a CPU and an FPGA.
1321 @item @file{target} ...
1322 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1323 on a chip
1324 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1325 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1326 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1327 the target config file defines all of them.
1328 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1329 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1330 @end itemize
1331
1332 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1333 file may override features in any of the above files by
1334 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1335 commands specific to their situation.
1336
1337 @section Interface Config Files
1338
1339 The user config file
1340 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1341
1342 @example
1343 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1344 @end example
1345
1346 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1347 in use today with OpenOCD.
1348 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1349 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1350
1351 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1352 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1353 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1354 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1355 and need to provide a driver for it.
1356
1357 @section Board Config Files
1358 @cindex config file, board
1359 @cindex board config file
1360
1361 The user config file
1362 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1363
1364 @example
1365 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1366 @end example
1367
1368 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1369 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1370 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1371
1372 @enumerate
1373 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1374 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1375 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1376 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1377 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1378 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1379 @end enumerate
1380
1381 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1382 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1383 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1384 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1385
1386 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1387 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1388 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1389 configuration works.
1390
1391 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1392
1393 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1394 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1395 convention on how to use certain variables.
1396
1397 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1398 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1399 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1400 used at will within a target configuration file.
1401
1402 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1403 for a board with three chips:
1404
1405 @example
1406 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1407 set CHIPNAME network
1408 set ENDIAN big
1409 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1410 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1411 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1412 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1413
1414 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1415 set CHIPNAME video
1416 set ENDIAN little
1417 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1418 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1419 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1420 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1421
1422 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1423 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1424 unset ENDIAN
1425 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1426 @end example
1427
1428 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1429 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1430 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1431 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1432 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1433 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1434 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1435 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1436
1437 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1438 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1439 naming collisions.
1440
1441 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1442 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1443 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1444 up other clocks and peripherals.
1445
1446 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1447 @cindex variable names
1448
1449 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1450 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1451 one such chip (as shown above).
1452 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1453 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1454 to promote consistency and
1455 so that board files can override target defaults.
1456
1457 Inputs to target config files include:
1458
1459 @itemize @bullet
1460 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1461 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1462 tap identifier dotted names.
1463 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1464 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1465 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1466 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1467 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1468 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1469 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1470 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1471 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1472 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1473 @end itemize
1474
1475 Outputs from target config files include:
1476
1477 @itemize @bullet
1478 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1479 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1480 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1481 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1482 specific to that board and that target.
1483 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1484 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1485 @end itemize
1486
1487 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1488 @cindex event, reset-init
1489 @cindex reset-init handler
1490
1491 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1492 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1493 fully set up yet.
1494 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1495 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1496 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1497 handler is one of the most important.
1498
1499 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1500 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1501 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1502 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1503 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1504
1505 @quotation Note
1506 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1507 are included here.
1508 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1509 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1510 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1511 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1512 @end quotation
1513
1514 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1515 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1516 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1517 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1518 those as parameters.
1519 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1520 and disabling the watchdog.
1521 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1522 the next developer doing such work.
1523 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1524
1525 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1526 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1527 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1528 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1529
1530 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1531
1532 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1533 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1534 a low JTAG clock rate.
1535 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1536 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1537 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1538 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1539 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1540 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1541 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1542
1543 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1544 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1545 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1546 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1547 which might be less than that.
1548
1549 @quotation Warning
1550 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1551 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1552 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1553 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1554 @end quotation
1555
1556 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1557 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1558 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1559 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1560 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1561 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1562
1563 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1564 @subsection The init_board procedure
1565 @cindex init_board procedure
1566
1567 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1568 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1569 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1570 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1571 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1572 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1573 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1574 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1575 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1576 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1577 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1578 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1579
1580 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1581 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1582
1583 @example
1584 ### board_file.cfg ###
1585
1586 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1587 source [find target/target.cfg]
1588
1589 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1590 # enables fast on-board clock source
1591 # configures the chip to use it
1592 @}
1593
1594 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1595 proc init_board @{@} @{
1596 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1597
1598 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1599 adapter_khz 100
1600 @}
1601
1602 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1603 enable_fast_clock
1604 adapter_khz 10000
1605 @}
1606 @}
1607 @end example
1608
1609 @section Target Config Files
1610 @cindex config file, target
1611 @cindex target config file
1612
1613 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1614 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1615 more target config files like this:
1616
1617 @example
1618 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1619 @end example
1620
1621 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1622 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1623 In summary the target files should contain
1624
1625 @enumerate
1626 @item Set defaults
1627 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1628 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1629 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1630 @item On-Chip flash
1631 @end enumerate
1632
1633 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1634 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1635 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1636
1637 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1638 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1639 can talk to the chip.
1640 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1641 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1642 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1643 and other processing engines.
1644
1645 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1646
1647 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1648 letting board config files express environment-specific
1649 differences in how things should be set up.
1650
1651 @example
1652 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1653 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1654 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1655 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1656 @} else @{
1657 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1658 @}
1659
1660 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1661 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1662 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1663 @} else @{
1664 set _ENDIAN little
1665 @}
1666
1667 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1668 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1669 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1670 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1671 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1672 @} else @{
1673 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1674 @}
1675 @end example
1676 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1677
1678 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1679 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1680 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1681
1682 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1683 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1684 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1685
1686 @example
1687 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1688 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1689 @end example
1690
1691 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1692 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1693 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1694 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1695 for taps.
1696
1697 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1698 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1699 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1700 looks (in part) like this:
1701
1702 @example
1703 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1704 @end example
1705
1706 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1707 to source such a config file twice, with different
1708 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1709 it adds a different TAP each time.
1710
1711 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1712 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1713 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1714 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1715
1716 @example
1717 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1718 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1719 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1720 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1721 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1722 @end example
1723
1724 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1725 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1726
1727 @itemize
1728 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1729 plus a JRC to enable them
1730 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1731 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1732 is not currently used)
1733 @end itemize
1734
1735 @subsection Add CPU targets
1736
1737 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1738 GDB and other commands can use it.
1739 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1740 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1741 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1742 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1743
1744 @example
1745 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1746 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1747 @end example
1748
1749 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1750 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1751 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1752 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1753 a work area if you can.
1754 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1755
1756 @example
1757 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1758 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1759 @end example
1760
1761 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1762 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1763 @cindex SMP
1764 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1765
1766 @example
1767 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1768 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1769 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1770 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1771 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1772 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1773 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1774 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1775 @end example
1776 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1777 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1778 @itemize @bullet
1779 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1780 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1781 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1782 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1783 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1784 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1785 @end itemize
1786
1787 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1788 command have been implemented.
1789 @itemize @bullet
1790 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1791 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1792 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1793 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1794 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1795 following example.
1796 @end itemize
1797
1798 @example
1799 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1800 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1801 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1802 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1803 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1804 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1805 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1806 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1807 > resume
1808 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1809 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1810 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1811 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1812 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1813 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1814 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1815 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1816 @end example
1817
1818
1819 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1820
1821 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1822 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1823 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1824
1825 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1826 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1827 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1828 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1829 both signals.
1830
1831 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1832 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1833 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1834 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1835 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1836 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1837 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1838 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1839 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1840 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1841 not available.)
1842
1843 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1844 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1845 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1846 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1847 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1848 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1849 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1850 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1851
1852 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1853 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1854 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1855 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1856 slower clock than they will use later.
1857 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1858 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1859 than they will use later.
1860 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1861
1862 @quotation Important
1863 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1864 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1865 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1866 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1867 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1868 @end quotation
1869
1870 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1871 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1872 @cindex init_targets procedure
1873
1874 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1875 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1876 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1877 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1878 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1879 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1880 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1881 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1882 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1883
1884 @example
1885 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1886
1887 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1888 # basic initialization procedure ...
1889 @}
1890
1891 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1892 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1893 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1894 @}
1895
1896 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1897
1898 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1899
1900 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1901 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1902 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1903 @}
1904 @end example
1905
1906 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1907 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1908
1909 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1910
1911 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1912 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1913
1914 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1915 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1916 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1917
1918 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1919 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1920 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1921 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1922 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1923 events already assigned.
1924
1925 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1926
1927 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1928 special high speed download features - enable it.
1929
1930 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1931
1932 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1933 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1934 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1935 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1936 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1937 If you are using an external trace port,
1938 configure it in your board config file.
1939 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1940 configure it in your target config file.
1941
1942 @example
1943 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1944 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1945 @end example
1946
1947 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1948
1949 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1950
1951 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1952 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1953 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1954 the TARGET (chip) file.
1955
1956 Examples:
1957 @itemize @bullet
1958 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1959 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1960 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1961 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1962 @end itemize
1963
1964 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1965 @section Translating Configuration Files
1966 @cindex translation
1967 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1968 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1969 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1970 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1971 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1972 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1973
1974 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1975 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1976 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1977 convert other scripts later on.
1978
1979 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1980 replace job:
1981
1982 @example
1983 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1984 #
1985 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1986 #
1987 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1988 #
1989 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1990
1991 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1992 global TARGETNAME
1993
1994 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1995
1996 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1997 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1998 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1999 @}
2000 @end example
2001
2002
2003
2004 @node Server Configuration
2005 @chapter Server Configuration
2006 @cindex initialization
2007 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2008 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2009 supported.
2010
2011 @anchor{configurationstage}
2012 @section Configuration Stage
2013 @cindex configuration stage
2014 @cindex config command
2015
2016 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2017 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2018 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2019 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2020 inside startup scripts.
2021
2022 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2023 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2024 which may be issued interactively.
2025 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2026 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2027
2028 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2029 flash banks,
2030 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2031 and other basic setup.
2032 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2033 may access or activate TAPs.
2034 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2035 longer be issued.
2036
2037 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2038 @section Entering the Run Stage
2039
2040 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2041 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2042 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2043 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2044 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2045 You should see no errors at this point.
2046 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2047 commands you used to configure the server.
2048 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2049 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2050 on the scan chain.
2051
2052 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2053 become available.
2054 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2055 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2056 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2057 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2058 entry to the run stage.
2059
2060 @deffn {Config Command} init
2061 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2062 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2063 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2064 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2065 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2066 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2067
2068 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2069 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2070 configuration files and/or command line options.
2071
2072 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2073 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2074 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2075 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2076 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2077 @end deffn
2078
2079 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2080 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2081 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2082
2083 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2084 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2085 scan chain.
2086 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2087 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2088
2089 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2090 they return.
2091 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2092 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2093 @end deffn
2094
2095 @anchor{tcpipports}
2096 @section TCP/IP Ports
2097 @cindex TCP port
2098 @cindex server
2099 @cindex port
2100 @cindex security
2101 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2102 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2103 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2104
2105 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2106 access using one or more of these ports.
2107 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2108 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2109 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2110
2111 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2112 @cindex GDB server
2113 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2114 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2115 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2116 the normal use cases.
2117
2118 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2119 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2120 disables the gdb server.
2121
2122 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2123 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2124
2125 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2126 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2127
2128 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2129 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2130 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2131
2132 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2133 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2134 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2135 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2136
2137 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2138 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2139 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2140
2141 @end deffn
2142
2143 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2144 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2145 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2146 output from the Tcl engine.
2147 Intended as a machine interface.
2148 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2149 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2150 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2151 @end deffn
2152
2153 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2154 Specify or query the
2155 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2156 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2157 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2158 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2159 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2160 @end deffn
2161
2162 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2163 @section GDB Configuration
2164 @cindex GDB
2165 @cindex GDB configuration
2166 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2167 The ones listed here are static and global.
2168 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2169 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2170
2171 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2172 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2173 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2174 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2175 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2176 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2177 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2178 @end deffn
2179
2180 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2181 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2182 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2183 vFlash packet is received.
2184 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2185 @end deffn
2186
2187 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2188 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2189 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2190 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2191 for flash programming to work.
2192 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2197 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2198 by GDB memory read packets.
2199 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2200 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2201 @end deffn
2202
2203 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2204 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2205 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2206 @end deffn
2207
2208 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2209 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2210
2211 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2212 @end deffn
2213
2214 @anchor{eventpolling}
2215 @section Event Polling
2216
2217 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2218 where significant events can happen at any time.
2219 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2220 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2221 or to GDB.
2222
2223 Examples of such events include:
2224
2225 @itemize
2226 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2227 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2228 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2229 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2230 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2231 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2232 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2233 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2234 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2235 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2236 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2237 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2238 @end itemize
2239
2240 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2241 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2242 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2243 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2244 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2245
2246 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2247 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2248 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2249 to the various active targets.
2250 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2251 which is normally done in the background.
2252
2253 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2254 Poll the current target for its current state.
2255 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2256 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2257 specific information about the current state is printed.
2258 An optional parameter
2259 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2260
2261 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2262 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2263 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2264 @example
2265 > poll
2266 background polling: on
2267 target state: halted
2268 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2269 current mode: Supervisor
2270 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2271 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2272 >
2273 @end example
2274 @end deffn
2275
2276 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2277 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2278 @cindex config file, interface
2279 @cindex interface config file
2280
2281 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2282 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2283 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2284
2285 @quotation Note
2286 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2287 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2288 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2289 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2290 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2291 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2292 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2293 @end quotation
2294
2295 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2296 through commands in an interface configuration
2297 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2298 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2299
2300 @example
2301 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2302 @end example
2303
2304 These commands tell
2305 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2306 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2307
2308 @example
2309 # jlink interface
2310 interface jlink
2311 @end example
2312
2313 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2314
2315
2316 @section Interface Configuration
2317
2318 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2319 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2320 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2321
2322 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2323 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2324 target.
2325 @end deffn
2326
2327 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2328 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2329 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2330 @end deffn
2331 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2332 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2333 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2334 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2335 the hardware can support.
2336 @end deffn
2337
2338
2339
2340 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2341 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2342 @end deffn
2343
2344 @section Interface Drivers
2345
2346 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2347 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2348 available at run time.
2349
2350 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2351 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2352 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2353 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2354
2355 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2356 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2357 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2358 @end deffn
2359
2360 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2361 Displays status of RTCK option.
2362 Optionally sets that option first.
2363 @end deffn
2364 @end deffn
2365
2366 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2367 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2368 This has one driver-specific command:
2369
2370 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2371 Logs some status
2372 @end deffn
2373 @end deffn
2374
2375 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2376 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2377 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2378 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2379 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2380 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2381 @end deffn
2382
2383 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2384 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2385
2386 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2387 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2388 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2389 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2390 @example
2391 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2392 @end example
2393 @end deffn
2394
2395 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2396 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2397 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2398 @end deffn
2399
2400 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2401 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2402 @end deffn
2403 @end deffn
2404
2405 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2406 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2407 @end deffn
2408
2409 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2410 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2411 @end deffn
2412
2413 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2414 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2415 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2416
2417 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2418 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2419
2420 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added competely through
2421 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2422
2423 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2424 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2425 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2426 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2427 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2428 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2429
2430 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2431 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2432 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2433 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2434 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2435
2436 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2437 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2438 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2439 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2440
2441 @itemize @minus
2442 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2443 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2444 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2445 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2446 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2447 switching data and direction as necessary
2448 @end itemize
2449
2450 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2451 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2452
2453 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2454 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2455 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2456 @example
2457 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2458 @end example
2459 @end deffn
2460
2461 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2462 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2463 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2464 during device selection.
2465 @end deffn
2466
2467 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2468 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2469 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2470 is connected to the host.
2471 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2472 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2473 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2474 @end deffn
2475
2476 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2477 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2478 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2479 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2480 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2481 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2482
2483 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2484 @end deffn
2485
2486 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2487 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2488 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2489 @end deffn
2490
2491 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2492 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2493 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2494 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2495 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2496 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2497 and initially asserted reset signals.
2498 @end deffn
2499
2500 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2501 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2502 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2503 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2504 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2505 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2506 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2507 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2508 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2509 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2510 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2511
2512 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2513 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2514 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2515 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2516 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2517 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2518
2519 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2520 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2521 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2522 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2523 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2524 are always driven by the FTDI.
2525
2526 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2527 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2528 @var{name}.
2529 @end deffn
2530
2531 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2532 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2533 @itemize @minus
2534 @item @option{0}, drive low
2535 @item @option{1}, drive high
2536 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2537 @end itemize
2538 @end deffn
2539
2540 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2541 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2542 @end deffn
2543
2544 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2545 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2546
2547 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2548 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possiblity to sample
2549 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2550 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2551 @itemize @minus
2552 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2553 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2554 @end itemize
2555 @end deffn
2556
2557 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2558 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2559
2560 @end deffn
2561
2562 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2563 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R
2564 USB UART bridge IC.
2565
2566 List of connections (pin numbers for SSOP):
2567 @itemize @minus
2568 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2569 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2570 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2571 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2572 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2573 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2574 @end itemize
2575
2576 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2577 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2578
2579 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2580 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2581 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2582 @end deffn
2583
2584 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2585 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2586 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2587 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2588 @end deffn
2589
2590 @end deffn
2591
2592 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2593 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2594 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2595 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2596
2597 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2598 processors which are being simulated.
2599
2600 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2601 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2602 sockets instead of TCP.
2603 @end deffn
2604
2605 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2606 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2607 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2608 @end deffn
2609
2610 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2611 something like:
2612
2613 @example
2614 interface remote_bitbang
2615 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2616 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2617 @end example
2618
2619 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2620 named mysocket:
2621
2622 @example
2623 interface remote_bitbang
2624 remote_bitbang_port 0
2625 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2626 @end example
2627 @end deffn
2628
2629 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2630 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2631 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2632 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2633
2634 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2635 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2636 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2637 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2638 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2639 @end deffn
2640
2641 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2642 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2643 default values are used.
2644 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2645 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2646 @example
2647 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2648 @end example
2649 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2650 @example
2651 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2652 @end example
2653 @end deffn
2654
2655 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2656 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2657 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2658 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2659 target board.
2660
2661 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2662 @example
2663 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2664 reset_config srst_only
2665 @end example
2666 @end deffn
2667
2668 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2669 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2670 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2671 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2672 @end deffn
2673
2674 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2675 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2676 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2677 @end deffn
2678
2679 @end deffn
2680
2681 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2682 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2683 This has one driver-specific command:
2684
2685 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2686 Display either the address of the I/O port
2687 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2688 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2689 This is a write-once setting.
2690 @end deffn
2691 @end deffn
2692
2693 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2694 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2695 transports.
2696
2697 @quotation Compatibility Note
2698 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2699 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2700 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2701 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2702 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2703 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2704 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2705 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2706 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2707 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2708 @end quotation
2709
2710 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2711 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2712 states.
2713 @end deffn
2714 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2715 Display free device internal memory.
2716 @end deffn
2717 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2718 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2719 command version.
2720 @end deffn
2721 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2722 Display the device configuration.
2723 @end deffn
2724 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2725 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2726 power state.
2727 @end deffn
2728 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2729 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2730 @end deffn
2731 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2732 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2733 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2734 IP configuration.
2735 @end deffn
2736 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2737 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2738 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2739 @end deffn
2740 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2741 Reset the current configuration.
2742 @end deffn
2743 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2744 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2745 @end deffn
2746 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2747 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2748 pairs.
2749
2750 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2751 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2752 @example
2753 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2754 @end example
2755 @end deffn
2756 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2757 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2758 pairs.
2759
2760 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2761 @example
2762 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2763 77a90000
2764 @end example
2765 @end deffn
2766 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2767 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2768 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2769 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2770 instead.
2771
2772 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2773 @end deffn
2774 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2775 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2776 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2777
2778 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2779 @end deffn
2780 @end deffn
2781
2782 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2783 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2784 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2785 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2786 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2787 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2788 configuration script.
2789
2790 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2791 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2792 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2793 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2794 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2795
2796 Known limitations:
2797 @itemize @bullet
2798 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2799 and 2.7 MHz.
2800 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2801 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2802 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2803 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2804 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2805 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2806 communications with the target.
2807 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2808 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2809 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2810 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2811 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2812 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2813 @end itemize
2814
2815 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2816 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2817 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2818 @end deffn
2819
2820 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2821 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2822 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2823 @end deffn
2824
2825 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2826 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2827 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2828 target as a side-effect.
2829 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2830 @end deffn
2831
2832 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2833 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2834 version, and target voltage.
2835 @end deffn
2836 @end deffn
2837
2838 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2839 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2840 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2841 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2842 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2843
2844 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2845 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2846 This is a write-once setting.
2847 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2848
2849 @itemize @minus
2850 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2851 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2852 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2853 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2854 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2855 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2856 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2857 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2858 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2859 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2860 some versions of
2861 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2862 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2863 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2864 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2865 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2866 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2867 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2868 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2869 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2870 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2871 @end itemize
2872 @end deffn
2873
2874 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2875 Display either the address of the I/O port
2876 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2877 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2878 This is a write-once setting.
2879
2880 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2881 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2882 you may encounter a problem.
2883 @end deffn
2884
2885 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2886 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2887 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2888 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2889 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2890 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2891
2892 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2893 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2894 @quotation Tip
2895 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2896 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2897 @example
2898 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2899 > adapter_khz 500
2900 @end example
2901 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2902 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2903 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2904 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2905 large set of samples.
2906 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2907 @example
2908 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2909 @end example
2910 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2911 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2912
2913 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2914 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2915 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2916 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2917 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2918 @end quotation
2919 @end deffn
2920
2921 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2922 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2923 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2924 @end deffn
2925
2926 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2927 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2928
2929 @example
2930 interface parport
2931 parport_port 0x278
2932 parport_cable wiggler
2933 @end example
2934 @end deffn
2935
2936 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2937 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2938 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2939 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2940 @end deffn
2941 @end deffn
2942
2943 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2944 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2945 @end deffn
2946
2947 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2948 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2949 @end deffn
2950
2951 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2952 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2953
2954 @quotation Note
2955 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2956 which are not currently documented here.
2957 @end quotation
2958 @end deffn
2959
2960 @anchor{hla_interface}
2961 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2962 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2963 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2964 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2965
2966 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2967 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2968 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2969 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2970 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2971
2972 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2973 Currently Not Supported.
2974 @end deffn
2975
2976 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2977 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2978 @end deffn
2979
2980 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2981 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2982 @end deffn
2983
2984 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2985 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
2986 @end deffn
2987
2988 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2989 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2990 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2991 @end deffn
2992 @end deffn
2993
2994 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2995 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2996 @end deffn
2997
2998 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2999 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3000 @end deffn
3001
3002 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3003 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3004 @end deffn
3005
3006 @quotation Note
3007 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3008 which are not currently documented here.
3009 @end quotation
3010
3011 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3012 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3013 No arguments: print status.
3014 @end deffn
3015
3016 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3017 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3018 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3019
3020 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3021 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3022 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3023 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3024 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3025 configuration on exit.
3026
3027 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3028 pinout.
3029
3030 @end deffn
3031
3032 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3033 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3034 of the one which is most popular.
3035
3036 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3037
3038 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3039 pinout.
3040
3041 @end deffn
3042
3043
3044 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3045 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3046 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3047
3048 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3049 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3050 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3051
3052 @itemize @minus
3053 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3054 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3055 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3056 @end itemize
3057 @end deffn
3058
3059 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3060 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3061 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3062 @end deffn
3063 @end deffn
3064
3065 @section Transport Configuration
3066 @cindex Transport
3067 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3068 and the debug adapter you are using,
3069 several transports may be available to
3070 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3071 @deffn Command {transport list}
3072 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3073 version of OpenOCD.
3074 @end deffn
3075
3076 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3077 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3078
3079 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3080 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3081 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3082 adapter's driver).
3083
3084 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3085 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3086 supported by the debug adapter.
3087
3088 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3089 transport, if any.
3090 @end deffn
3091
3092 @subsection JTAG Transport
3093 @cindex JTAG
3094 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3095 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3096 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3097 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3098 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3099 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3100
3101 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3102 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3103 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3104 hla_jtag}.
3105
3106 @subsection SWD Transport
3107 @cindex SWD
3108 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3109 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3110 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3111 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3112 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3113 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3114 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3115
3116 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3117 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3118 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3119 hla_swd}.
3120
3121 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3122 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3123 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3124 expected to change.
3125 @end deffn
3126 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3127 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3128 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3129 No parameters: displays current settings.
3130 @end deffn
3131
3132 @subsection SPI Transport
3133 @cindex SPI
3134 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3135 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3136 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3137 solution for flash programming.
3138
3139 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3140 @section JTAG Speed
3141 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3142 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3143 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3144 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3145 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3146 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3147 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3148 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3149 power management software that may be active.
3150
3151 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3152 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3153 target event handler.
3154 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3155 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3156 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3157 sets up those clocks).
3158 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3159 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3160 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3161 in the target config file.
3162 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3163 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3164 config file instead.
3165 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3166 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3167 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3168
3169 @example
3170 jtag_rclk 3000
3171 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3172 @end example
3173
3174 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3175 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3176 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3177 may not be the fastest solution.
3178
3179 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3180 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3181 which support adaptive clocking.
3182
3183 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3184 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3185 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3186 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3187 than the speed specified.
3188
3189 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3190 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3191 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3192 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3193
3194 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3195 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3196 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3197 JTAG clocking after setup.
3198 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3199 If the interface device can not
3200 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3201 @end deffn
3202
3203 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3204 @cindex adaptive clocking
3205 @cindex RTCK
3206 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3207 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3208 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3209 @example
3210 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3211 jtag_rclk 3000
3212 @end example
3213 @end defun
3214
3215 @node Reset Configuration
3216 @chapter Reset Configuration
3217 @cindex Reset Configuration
3218
3219 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3220 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3221 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3222 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3223 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3224 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3225 Please see the various board files for examples.
3226
3227 @quotation Note
3228 To maintainers and integrators:
3229 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3230 Normally the board configuration file
3231 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3232 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3233
3234 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3235 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3236 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3237 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3238 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3239 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3240 @end quotation
3241
3242 @section Types of Reset
3243
3244 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3245 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3246 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3247
3248 @itemize @bullet
3249 @item
3250 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3251 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3252 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3253 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3254 @item
3255 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3256 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3257 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3258 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3259 @item
3260 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3261 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3262 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3263 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3264 @item
3265 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3266 several other types of reset.
3267 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3268 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3269 There may be individual module resets.
3270 @end itemize
3271
3272 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3273 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3274 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3275 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3276 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3277 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3278 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3279 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3280 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3281
3282 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3283 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3284
3285 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3286 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3287 common issues are:
3288
3289 @itemize @bullet
3290
3291 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3292 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3293 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3294 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3295 when either of those signals is not connected.
3296 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3297 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3298 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3299 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3300
3301 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3302 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3303 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3304 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3305
3306 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3307 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3308 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3309 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3310 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3311 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3312 hardware debouncing.
3313 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3314 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3315
3316 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3317 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3318 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3319 to use push/pull output drivers.
3320 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3321 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3322 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3323 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3324
3325 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3326 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3327 issues (not limited to errata).
3328 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3329 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3330 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3331 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3332 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3333 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3334 @end itemize
3335
3336 There can also be other issues.
3337 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3338 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3339 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3340 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3341 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3342 Agreement (NDA).
3343
3344 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3345 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3346 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3347
3348 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3349 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3350
3351 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3352
3353 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3354 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3355 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3356 allowing it to be deasserted.
3357 @end deffn
3358
3359 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3360 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3361 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3362 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3363 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3364 @end deffn
3365
3366 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3367 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3368 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3369 allowing it to be deasserted.
3370 @end deffn
3371
3372 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3373 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3374 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3375 @end deffn
3376
3377 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3378 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3379 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3380 configuration scripts.
3381
3382 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3383 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3384 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3385 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3386 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3387 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3388 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3389 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3390
3391 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3392 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3393 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3394 -- may be specified at a time.
3395 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3396 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3397 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3398 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3399 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3400
3401 @itemize
3402 @item
3403 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3404 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3405 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3406 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3407 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3408
3409 @quotation Tip
3410 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3411 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3412 @end quotation
3413
3414 @item
3415 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3416 signal implementations.
3417 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3418 indicating everything behaves normally.
3419 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3420 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3421 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3422 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3423 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3424 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3425 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3426
3427 @item
3428 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3429 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3430 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3431 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3432 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3433 while SRST is asserted.
3434 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3435 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3436
3437 @item
3438 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3439 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3440 is required to use this option.
3441 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3442 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3443 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3444 be asserted before any target connection.
3445 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3446 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3447 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3448 @end itemize
3449
3450 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3451 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3452 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3453 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3454 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3455
3456 @itemize
3457 @item
3458 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3459 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3460 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3461 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3462
3463 @item
3464 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3465 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3466 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3467 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3468 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3469 @end itemize
3470 @end deffn
3471
3472 @section Custom Reset Handling
3473 @cindex events
3474
3475 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3476 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3477 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3478 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3479 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3480 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3481
3482 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3483 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3484 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3485 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3486 want to reset everything at once.
3487
3488 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3489 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3490 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3491 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3492 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3493 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3494 needs special attention.
3495
3496 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3497 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3498 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3499 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3500 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3501 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3502 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3503 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3504
3505 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3506 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3507 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3508 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3509 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3510
3511 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3512 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3513 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3514 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3515 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3516 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3517 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3518 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3519 or potentially some other value.
3520
3521 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3522 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3523 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3524 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3525 (or their associated targets)
3526 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3527
3528 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3529 they return.
3530 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3531 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3532 @end deffn
3533
3534 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3535 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3536 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3537 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3538 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3539 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3540 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3541 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3542 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3543 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3544 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3545 @end deffn
3546
3547 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3548 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3549 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3550 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3551 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3552 @end deffn
3553
3554
3555 @node TAP Declaration
3556 @chapter TAP Declaration
3557 @cindex TAP declaration
3558 @cindex TAP configuration
3559
3560 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3561 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3562
3563 @itemize @bullet
3564 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3565 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3566 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3567 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3568 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3569 start running that code.
3570 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3571 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3572 and missing connections.
3573 @end itemize
3574
3575 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3576 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3577 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3578 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3579 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3580
3581 @section Scan Chains
3582 @cindex scan chain
3583
3584 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3585 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3586 They also need to be added to
3587 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3588 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3589 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3590 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3591 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3592 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3593 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3594 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3595
3596 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3597 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3598 command, presented in the next chapter.
3599 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3600 debugging targets.)
3601 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3602
3603 @verbatim
3604 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3605 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3606 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3607 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3608 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3609 @end verbatim
3610
3611 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3612 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3613 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3614 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3615 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3616 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3617 until they are told to do so.
3618
3619 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3620 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3621 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3622 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3623
3624 @example
3625 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3626 @end example
3627
3628 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3629 by a given chip.
3630 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3631 and so forth.
3632 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3633 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3634 both inside a single chip and between them.
3635 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3636
3637 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3638 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3639 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3640 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3641 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3642 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3643 includes commands something like this:
3644
3645 @example
3646 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3647 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3648 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3649 @end example
3650
3651 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3652 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3653 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3654
3655 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3656 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3657 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3658 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3659 @example
3660 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3661 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3662 @}
3663 @end example
3664 @end deffn
3665
3666 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3667 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3668 and their status.
3669 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3670 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3671 but systems with a JTAG router can
3672 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3673 @end deffn
3674
3675 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3676 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3677
3678 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3679 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3680
3681 @section TAP Names
3682 @cindex dotted name
3683
3684 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3685 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3686 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3687 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3688 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3689 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3690 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3691 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3692
3693 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3694 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3695 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3696
3697 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3698
3699 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3700 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3701 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3702 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3703
3704 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3705 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3706 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3707 overridable.
3708
3709 @cindex TAP naming convention
3710 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3711 and should follow this convention:
3712
3713 @itemize @bullet
3714 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3715 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3716 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3717 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3718 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3719 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3720 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3721 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3722 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3723 with a single TAP;
3724 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3725 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3726 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3727 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3728 @end itemize
3729
3730 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3731
3732 @itemize @bullet
3733 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3734 @*The length in bits of the
3735 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3736 @end itemize
3737
3738 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3739
3740 @itemize @bullet
3741 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3742 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3743 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3744 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3745 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3746 (the TAP is linked in).
3747 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3748 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3749 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3750 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3751 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3752 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3753 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3754 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3755 values that were found but not included in the list.
3756
3757 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3758 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3759 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3760 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3761 hardware to find these values.
3762 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3763 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3764 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3765 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3766 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3767 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3768 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3769 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3770 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3771 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3772 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3773 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3774 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3775 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3776 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3777 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3778 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3779 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3780 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3781 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3782 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
3783 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
3784 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
3785 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
3786 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
3787 @end itemize
3788 @end deffn
3789
3790 @section Other TAP commands
3791
3792 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3793 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3794 At this writing this TAP attribute
3795 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3796 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3797 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3798 See the next section for information about the available events.
3799
3800 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3801 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3802 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3803 @end deffn
3804
3805 @section TAP Events
3806 @cindex events
3807 @cindex TAP events
3808
3809 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3810 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3811 The other applies to debugger targets,
3812 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3813
3814 The TAP events currently defined are:
3815
3816 @itemize @bullet
3817 @item @b{post-reset}
3818 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3819 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3820 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3821 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3822 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3823
3824 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3825 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3826 of any particular target.
3827 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3828 @item @b{setup}
3829 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3830 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3831 @item @b{tap-disable}
3832 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3833 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3834 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3835 @item @b{tap-enable}
3836 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3837 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3838 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3839 @end itemize
3840
3841 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3842 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3843 contents to be accurate), you might:
3844
3845 @example
3846 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3847 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3848 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3849 @}
3850 @end example
3851
3852
3853 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3854 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3855 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3856 @cindex jrc
3857
3858 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3859 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3860 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3861 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3862 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3863
3864 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3865 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3866 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3867 be visible.
3868 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3869 ignores, such as:
3870
3871 @itemize
3872 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3873 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3874 TAPs receive new instructions.
3875 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3876 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3877 @end itemize
3878
3879 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3880 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3881 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3882 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3883
3884 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3885 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3886
3887 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3888 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3889 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3890 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3891 should define TAP event handlers using
3892 code that looks something like this:
3893
3894 @example
3895 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3896 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3897 @}
3898 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3899 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3900 @}
3901 @end example
3902
3903 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3904
3905 @example
3906 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3907 @end example
3908
3909 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3910 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3911 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3912 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3913
3914 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3915 If necessary, disables the tap
3916 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3917 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3918 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3919 and "0" if it is disabled.
3920 @end deffn
3921
3922 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3923 If necessary, enables the tap
3924 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3925 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3926 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3927 and "0" if it is disabled.
3928 @end deffn
3929
3930 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3931 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3932 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3933 and "0" if it is disabled.
3934
3935 @quotation Note
3936 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3937 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3938 @end quotation
3939 @end deffn
3940
3941 @anchor{autoprobing}
3942 @section Autoprobing
3943 @cindex autoprobe
3944 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3945
3946 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3947 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3948 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3949 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3950
3951 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3952 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3953 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3954 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3955 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3956 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3957 right when they come out of reset).
3958
3959 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3960
3961 @example
3962 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3963 reset_config trst_and_srst
3964 jtag_rclk 8
3965 @end example
3966
3967 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3968 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3969
3970 @enumerate
3971 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3972 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3973 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3974 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3975 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3976 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3977 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3978 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3979 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3980 that is discovered.
3981 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3982 register, it will report it.
3983 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3984 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3985 @end enumerate
3986
3987 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3988 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3989 that's a bit more complex:
3990
3991 @example
3992 clock speed 8 kHz
3993 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3994 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3995 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3996 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3997 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3998 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3999 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4000 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4001 @end example
4002
4003 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4004 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4005 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4006 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4007 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4008 and so forth.
4009
4010 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4011 @section DAP declaration (ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4012 @cindex DAP declaration
4013
4014 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4015 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4016 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all
4017 ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4018 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4019
4020 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4021
4022 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4023 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4024 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4025 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4026 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4027
4028 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4029
4030 @itemize @bullet
4031 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4032 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4033 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4034 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4035 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4036 @end itemize
4037 @end deffn
4038
4039 @deffn Command {dap names}
4040 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4041 for TCL scripting.
4042 @end deffn
4043
4044 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4045 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4046 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4047 @end deffn
4048
4049 @deffn Command {dap init}
4050 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4051 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4052 initialization, too.
4053 @end deffn
4054
4055 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4056
4057 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4058 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4059 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4060 @end deffn
4061
4062 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4063 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4064 @end deffn
4065
4066 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4067 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4068 or set a new value @var{value}.
4069 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4070 @end deffn
4071
4072 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4073 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4074 @end deffn
4075
4076 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4077 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4078 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4079 @end deffn
4080
4081 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4082 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4083 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4084 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4085 @end deffn
4086
4087 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [0 / 1]
4088 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
4089 Defaulting to 0.
4090 @end deffn
4091
4092 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4093 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4094 Disabled by default
4095 @end deffn
4096
4097
4098 @node CPU Configuration
4099 @chapter CPU Configuration
4100 @cindex GDB target
4101
4102 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4103 You can also access these targets without GDB
4104 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4105 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4106 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4107 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4108
4109 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4110 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4111
4112 @section Target List
4113 @cindex target, current
4114 @cindex target, list
4115
4116 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4117 where each member has a name.
4118 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4119 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4120 (plural!) command.
4121 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4122 look like with more than one:
4123 @verbatim
4124 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4125 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4126 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4127 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4128 @end verbatim
4129
4130 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4131 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4132 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4133 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4134 space seen by that current target.
4135 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4136 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4137 are examples; and there are many more.
4138
4139 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4140
4141 @deffn Command {target current}
4142 Returns the name of the current target.
4143 @end deffn
4144
4145 @deffn Command {target names}
4146 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4147 @example
4148 foreach t [target names] @{
4149 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4150 @}
4151 @end example
4152 @end deffn
4153
4154 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4155 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4156
4157 @deffn Command targets [name]
4158 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4159 command names are singular.}
4160
4161 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4162 targets in a user friendly form.
4163
4164 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4165 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4166 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4167 @end deffn
4168
4169 @section Target CPU Types
4170 @cindex target type
4171 @cindex CPU type
4172
4173 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4174 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4175 when calling @command{target create}.
4176 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4177 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4178 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4179 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4180 what core-specific commands may be available
4181 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4182 and more.
4183
4184 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4185 since there's a command to list them.
4186
4187 @anchor{targettypes}
4188 @deffn Command {target types}
4189 Lists all supported target types.
4190 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4191
4192 @itemize @bullet
4193 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4194 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4195 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4196 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4197 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4198 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4199 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4200 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4201 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4202 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4203 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4204 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4205 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU
4206 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4207 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4208 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4209 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4210 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4211 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4212 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4213 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4214 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4215 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4216 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4217 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4218 @itemize @minus
4219 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4220 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4221 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4222 @end itemize
4223 And two debug interfaces cores:
4224 @itemize @minus
4225 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4226 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4227 @end itemize
4228 @end itemize
4229 @end deffn
4230
4231 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4232 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4233 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4234 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4235 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4236 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4237 reflect design generations;
4238 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4239 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4240
4241 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4242 @section Target Configuration
4243
4244 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4245 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4246 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4247 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4248 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4249
4250 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4251 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4252 optional parts.
4253 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4254 command, created as part of target creation.
4255
4256 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4257 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4258 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4259 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4260 to be much more board-specific.
4261 The key steps you use might look something like this
4262
4263 @example
4264 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4265 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4266 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4267 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4268 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4269 @end example
4270
4271 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4272 on-chip SRAM.
4273 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4274 writes to target memory;
4275 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4276 GDB memory checksumming;
4277 and more.
4278
4279 @quotation Warning
4280 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4281 inaccessible when application code
4282 (such as an operating system)
4283 enables or disables the MMU.
4284 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4285 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4286 easy access to other addresses needed.
4287 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4288 @end quotation
4289
4290 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4291 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4292 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4293 controllers.
4294 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4295 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4296 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4297
4298 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4299 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4300 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4301 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4302 purposes including additional configuration.
4303
4304 @itemize @bullet
4305 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4306 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4307 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4308 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4309
4310 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4311 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4312 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4313 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4314 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4315 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4316 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4317
4318 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4319 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4320 @end itemize
4321 @end deffn
4322
4323 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4324 The options accepted by this command may also be
4325 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4326 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4327 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4328
4329 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4330 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4331 and changing its endianness.
4332
4333 @itemize @bullet
4334
4335 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4336 used to access this target.
4337
4338 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4339 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4340 create and manage DAP instances.
4341
4342 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4343 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4344
4345 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4346 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4347 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4348 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4349 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4350 same event name assigns only one handler.
4351
4352 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4353 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4354
4355 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4356 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4357 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4358 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4359 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4360 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4361 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4362
4363 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4364 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4365 or virtual address is being used.
4366
4367 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4368 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4369
4370 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4371 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4372 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4373 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4374 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4375
4376 @anchor{rtostype}
4377 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4378 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4379 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4380 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}
4381 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4382
4383 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4384 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4385 access the target for debugging.
4386
4387 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4388 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4389 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4390 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4391
4392 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4393 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4394 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4395 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4396 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4397 @end itemize
4398 @end deffn
4399
4400 @section Other $target_name Commands
4401 @cindex object command
4402
4403 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4404 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4405
4406 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4407 Once a button is created a button
4408 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4409 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4410 configure it like this:
4411
4412 @example
4413 # Create
4414 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4415 # Modify
4416 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4417 # Query
4418 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4419 # Report
4420 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4421 @end example
4422
4423 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4424 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4425
4426 @example
4427 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4428 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4429 @end example
4430
4431 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4432
4433 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4434 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4435 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4436 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4437 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4438 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4439 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4440 They are not otherwise documented here.
4441 @end deffn
4442
4443 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4444 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4445 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4446 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4447 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4448 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4449 the target side uses raw memory.
4450
4451 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4452 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4453 The script orientation comes from working with data
4454 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4455 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4456 and neither store nor return those values.
4457
4458 @itemize
4459 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4460 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4461 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4462 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4463 @end itemize
4464 @end deffn
4465
4466 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4467 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4468 @command{$target_name configure}
4469 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4470 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4471 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4472 There are a few special cases:
4473
4474 @itemize @bullet
4475 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4476 event named @var{event_name}.
4477 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4478 two parameters.
4479 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4480 This is a special case because this is set using
4481 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4482 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4483 @end itemize
4484
4485 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4486 all the targets you might use something like this:
4487
4488 @example
4489 foreach name [target names] @{
4490 set y [$name cget -endian]
4491 set z [$name cget -type]
4492 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4493 $x $name $y $z]
4494 @}
4495 @end example
4496 @end deffn
4497
4498 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4499 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4500 Displays the current target state:
4501 @code{debug-running},
4502 @code{halted},
4503 @code{reset},
4504 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4505 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4506 @end deffn
4507
4508 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4509 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4510 currently associated with this target.
4511 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4512 @end deffn
4513
4514 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4515 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4516 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4517 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4518 @end deffn
4519
4520 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4521 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4522 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4523 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4524 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4525 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4526 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4527 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4528 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4529 @end deffn
4530
4531 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4532 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4533 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4534 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4535 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4536 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4537 @end deffn
4538
4539 @anchor{targetevents}
4540 @section Target Events
4541 @cindex target events
4542 @cindex events
4543 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4544 For example:
4545 @itemize @bullet
4546 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4547 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4548 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4549 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4550 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4551 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4552 to set up system clocks or
4553 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4554 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4555 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4556 @end itemize
4557
4558 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4559 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4560 @command{target create ... -event}.
4561
4562 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4563 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4564 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4565
4566 @example
4567 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4568 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4569 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4570 @}
4571 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4572 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4573 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4574 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4575 @}
4576 @end example
4577
4578 The following target events are defined:
4579
4580 @itemize @bullet
4581 @item @b{debug-halted}
4582 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4583 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4584 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4585 @item @b{early-halted}
4586 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4587 @item @b{examine-start}
4588 @* Before target examine is called.
4589 @item @b{examine-end}
4590 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4591 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4592 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4593 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4594 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4595 connect GDB to running target.
4596 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4597 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4598 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4599 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4600 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4601 is in RAM or read only memory.
4602 Default is @code{halt}
4603 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4604 @* When GDB disconnects
4605 @item @b{gdb-end}
4606 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4607 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4608 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4609 @code{reset init})
4610 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4611 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4612 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4613 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4614 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4615 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4616 @item @b{gdb-start}
4617 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4618 @item @b{halted}
4619 @* The target has halted
4620 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4621 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4622 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4623 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4624 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4625 @item @b{reset-assert}
4626 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4627 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4628 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4629 it instead of asserting SRST.
4630 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4631 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4632 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4633 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4634 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4635 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4636 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4637 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4638 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4639 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4640 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4641 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4642 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4643 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4644 released on the scan chain.
4645 @item @b{reset-end}
4646 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4647 @item @b{reset-init}
4648 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4649 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4650
4651 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4652 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4653 multiplexing, and so on.
4654 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4655 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4656 @item @b{reset-start}
4657 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4658 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4659
4660 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4661 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4662 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4663 @item @b{resume-start}
4664 @* Before any target is resumed
4665 @item @b{resume-end}
4666 @* After all targets have resumed
4667 @item @b{resumed}
4668 @* Target has resumed
4669 @item @b{trace-config}
4670 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4671 @end itemize
4672
4673 @node Flash Commands
4674 @chapter Flash Commands
4675
4676 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4677 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4678 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4679 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4680 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4681 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4682 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4683 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4684 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4685
4686 Flash Steps:
4687 @enumerate
4688 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4689 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4690 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4691 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4692 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4693 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4694 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4695 @item GDB Flashing
4696 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4697 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4698 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4699 @end enumerate
4700
4701 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4702 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4703 so that it can't boot.
4704 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4705 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4706
4707 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4708 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4709 @cindex flash configuration
4710
4711 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4712 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4713 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4714 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4715 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4716 see the driver-specific documentation.
4717
4718 @itemize @bullet
4719 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4720 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4721 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4722 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4723 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4724 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4725 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4726 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4727 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4728 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4729 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4730 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4731 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4732 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4733 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4734 commands to the flash controller.
4735 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4736 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4737 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4738 for more information.
4739 @end itemize
4740 @quotation Note
4741 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4742 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4743 @end quotation
4744 @end deffn
4745
4746 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4747 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4748 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4749 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4750 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4751 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4752 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4753 @end deffn
4754
4755 @deffn Command {flash list}
4756 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4757 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4758 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4759 @end deffn
4760
4761 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4762 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4763 depends on the flash type.
4764 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4765 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4766 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4767 but most don't bother.
4768 @end deffn
4769
4770 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4771 @cindex flash erasing
4772 @cindex flash reading
4773 @cindex flash writing
4774 @cindex flash programming
4775 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4776
4777 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4778 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4779 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4780 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4781 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4782
4783 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4784 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4785 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4786 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4787 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4788
4789 @quotation Note
4790 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4791 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4792 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4793 back to a flash bank.
4794 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4795 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4796 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4797 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4798 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4799 @end quotation
4800
4801 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4802 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4803 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4804 disabled first.
4805 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4806 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4807 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4808
4809 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4810 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4811 up to and including @var{last}.
4812 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4813 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4814 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4815 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4816 @end deffn
4817
4818 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4819 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4820 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4821 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4822 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4823 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4824 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4825 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4826 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4827 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4828 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4829 before erase starts.
4830 @end deffn
4831
4832 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4833 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4834 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4835 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4836 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4837 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4838 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4839 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4840 before issuing this command.
4841 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4842 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4843 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4844 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4845 @end deffn
4846 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4847
4848 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
4849 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4850 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
4851 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
4852 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4853 @end deffn
4854
4855 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
4856 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
4857 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
4858 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
4859 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
4860 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4861 @end deffn
4862
4863 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
4864 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
4865 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
4866 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
4867 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4868 @end deffn
4869
4870 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4871 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4872 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4873 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4874 to the base address for each section in the image.
4875 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4876 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4877 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4878 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4879 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4880 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4881 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4882 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4883 each image section.
4884
4885 @quotation Warning
4886 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4887 data you want to preserve.
4888 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4889 sections might be erased with no notice.
4890 @itemize
4891 @item
4892 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4893 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4894 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4895 @item
4896 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4897 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4898 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4899 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4900 @end itemize
4901 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4902 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4903 @end quotation
4904
4905 @end deffn
4906
4907 @section Other Flash commands
4908 @cindex flash protection
4909
4910 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4911 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4912 and display that status.
4913 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4914 @end deffn
4915
4916 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
4917 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
4918 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
4919
4920 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4921 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4922 and possibly stale information.
4923 @end deffn
4924
4925 @anchor{flashprotect}
4926 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4927 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
4928 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
4929 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4930 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
4931 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4932 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4933 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
4934 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
4935 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
4936 @end deffn
4937
4938 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4939 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4940 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4941 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4942 @end deffn
4943
4944 @anchor{program}
4945 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4946 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4947 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4948 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4949 @end deffn
4950
4951 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4952 @section Flash Driver List
4953 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4954 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4955 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4956
4957 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
4958 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
4959 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
4960
4961 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
4962
4963 @itemize
4964 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
4965 @end itemize
4966
4967 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
4968 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
4969 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
4970 @example
4971 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4972 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
4973 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4974 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
4975 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4976 @end example
4977 @end deffn
4978
4979 @subsection External Flash
4980
4981 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4982 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4983 @cindex CFI
4984 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4985 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4986 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4987 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4988 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4989 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4990 configure a bus and its timings), or
4991 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4992 on the flash chip.
4993 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4994 speed up operation.
4995
4996 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4997
4998 @itemize
4999 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5000 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5001 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5002 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5003 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5004 swapped when writing data values (ie. not CFI commands).
5005 @end itemize
5006
5007 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5008 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5009
5010 @example
5011 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5012 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5013 @end example
5014
5015 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5016 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5017 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5018
5019 @example
5020 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5021 @end example
5022
5023 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5024 @end deffn
5025
5026 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5027 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5028 @cindex SPI
5029 @cindex jtagspi
5030 @cindex bscan_spi
5031 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5032 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5033 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5034 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5035 accessed through JTAG.
5036
5037 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5038 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5039 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5040 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5041 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5042 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5043
5044 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5045 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5046 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5047 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5048 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5049 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5050 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5051 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5052
5053 @itemize
5054 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5055 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5056 @var{USER1} instruction.
5057 @end itemize
5058
5059 @example
5060 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5061 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5062 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5063 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5064 @end example
5065 @end deffn
5066
5067 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5068 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5069 @cindex xcf
5070 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5071 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5072 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5073 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5074 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5075
5076 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5077 command accepts additional parameters:
5078 @itemize
5079 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5080 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5081 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5082 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5083 in master mode.
5084 @end itemize
5085 @example
5086 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5087 @end example
5088 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5089 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5090 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5091 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5092 dedicated sector.
5093 @end deffn
5094
5095 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5096 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5097 button.
5098 @example
5099 xcf configure 0
5100 @end example
5101 @end deffn
5102
5103 Additional driver notes:
5104 @itemize
5105 @item Only single revision supported.
5106 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5107 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5108 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5109 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5110 @end itemize
5111 @end deffn
5112
5113 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5114 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5115 @cindex SPIFI
5116 @cindex lpcspifi
5117 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5118 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5119 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5120
5121 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5122 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5123 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5124 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5125 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5126
5127 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5128 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5129 are configured by the driver.
5130
5131 @example
5132 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5133 @end example
5134
5135 @end deffn
5136
5137 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5138 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5139 @cindex SMI
5140 @cindex stmsmi
5141 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5142 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5143 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5144 SPI flash devices.
5145 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5146 flash devices can be connected.
5147
5148 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5149 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5150 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5151 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5152 the flash content.
5153
5154 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5155 to identify the memory bank.
5156 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5157 flash size, are detected automatically.
5158
5159 @example
5160 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5161 @end example
5162
5163 @end deffn
5164
5165 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5166 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5167 Microcontroller platform.
5168
5169 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5170 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5171
5172 @example
5173 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5174 @end example
5175
5176 @end deffn
5177
5178 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5179 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5180 @cindex ath79
5181 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5182 chip selects.
5183 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5184 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5185 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5186 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5187 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5188 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5189
5190 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5191 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5192 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5193 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5194 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5195 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5196 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5197 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5198 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5199 with the default CS0.
5200 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5201 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5202 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5203
5204 @example
5205 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5206
5207 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5208 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5209 # banks.
5210 flash bank flash0 ath79 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5211 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5212 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5213 @end example
5214
5215 @end deffn
5216
5217 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5218
5219 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5220 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5221 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5222 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5223 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5224 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5225
5226 @example
5227 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5228 @end example
5229 @end deffn
5230
5231 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5232 @cindex ambiqmicro
5233 @cindex apollo
5234 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5235 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5236 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5237 with the target using SWD.
5238
5239 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5240 the device class of the MCU.
5241 The Flash and Sram sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5242 to set up the flash banks.
5243 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5244 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5245
5246 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5247 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5248 and the second bank starts after the first.
5249
5250 @example
5251 # Flash bank 0
5252 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5253 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5254 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5255 $_TARGETNAME
5256 @end example
5257
5258 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5259 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5260 are available to the user.
5261
5262 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5263
5264 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5265 Erase entire bank.
5266 @end deffn
5267 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5268 Erase device pages.
5269 @end deffn
5270 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5271 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5272 The user writes sectors to sram starting at 0x10000010.
5273 Program OTP will write these sectors from sram to flash, and write protect
5274 the flash.
5275 @end deffn
5276 @end deffn
5277
5278 @anchor{at91samd}
5279 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5280 @cindex at91samd
5281 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5282 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5283 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5284
5285 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5286 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5287 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5288 processor to be halted.
5289 @end deffn
5290
5291 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5292 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5293 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5294 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5295 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5296 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5297
5298 @example
5299 at91samd set-security enable
5300 @end example
5301 @end deffn
5302
5303 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5304 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5305 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5306 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5307 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5308 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
5309 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5310 in order to disable this feature.
5311
5312 @example
5313 at91samd eeprom
5314 at91samd eeprom 1024
5315 @end example
5316 @end deffn
5317
5318 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5319 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5320 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5321 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5322 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5323 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5324
5325 @example
5326 at91samd bootloader
5327 at91samd bootloader 16384
5328 @end example
5329 @end deffn
5330
5331 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5332 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5333 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5334 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5335 @end deffn
5336
5337 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5338 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5339 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5340 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5341 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5342 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5343 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5344 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5345
5346 @example
5347 # Read user row
5348 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5349 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5350 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5351 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5352 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5353 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5354 @end example
5355 @end deffn
5356
5357 @end deffn
5358
5359 @anchor{at91sam3}
5360 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5361 @cindex at91sam3
5362 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5363 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5364 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5365 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5366 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5367 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5368 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
5369 chips are confirmed.}
5370
5371 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5372 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5373 the following fixed locations:
5374
5375 @example
5376 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5377 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5378 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5379 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5380 @end example
5381
5382 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5383 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5384 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5385
5386 @itemize
5387 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5388 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5389 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5390 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5391 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5392 @end itemize
5393
5394 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5395
5396 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5397 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5398 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5399 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5400 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5401 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5402 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5403
5404 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5405 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5406 @end deffn
5407
5408 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5409 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5410 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5411 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5412 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5413 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5414 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5415 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5416 @end deffn
5417
5418 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5419 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5420 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5421 @end deffn
5422 @end deffn
5423
5424 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5425 @cindex at91sam4
5426 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5427 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5428 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5429 @end deffn
5430
5431 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5432 @cindex at91sam4l
5433 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5434 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5435 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5436
5437 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5438 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5439 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5440 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5441 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5442 @end deffn
5443 @end deffn
5444
5445 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5446 @cindex atsamv
5447 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5448 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5449 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5450 @end deffn
5451
5452 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5453 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5454 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5455 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5456 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5457
5458 @example
5459 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5460 @end example
5461
5462 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5463 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5464
5465 @itemize
5466 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5467 @item @var{banks}
5468 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5469 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5470 @item @var{pages_size}
5471 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5472 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5473 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5474 @end itemize
5475
5476 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5477 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5478 will be autoconfigured.
5479 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5480
5481 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5482 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5483 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5484 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5485 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5486
5487 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5488 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5489 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5490 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5491 are not truly general purpose).
5492 @quotation Note
5493 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5494 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5495 @end quotation
5496 @end deffn
5497 @end deffn
5498
5499 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5500 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5501 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5502 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5503 @end deffn
5504
5505 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5506 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1 and BlueNRG-2 Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0 core and internal flash memory.
5507 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5508 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5509
5510 @example
5511 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5512 @end example
5513
5514 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5515 each single sector one by one.
5516
5517 @example
5518 flash erase_sector 0 0 79 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-1
5519 @end example
5520
5521 @example
5522 flash erase_sector 0 0 127 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-2
5523 @end example
5524
5525 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5526
5527 @end deffn
5528
5529 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5530 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5531 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5532 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5533 autoconfigures itself.
5534 @example
5535 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5536 @end example
5537 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5538 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5539 this via the following command:
5540 @example
5541 efm32 debuglock num
5542 @end example
5543 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5544 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5545 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5546 supported.}
5547 @end deffn
5548
5549 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5550 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5551 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5552 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5553 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5554 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5555 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5556
5557 @example
5558 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5559 @end example
5560 @end deffn
5561
5562 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5563 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5564 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5565 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5566 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5567 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5568 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5569 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5570 characters) ignored.
5571
5572 @example
5573 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
5574 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5575 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
5576 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5577 @end example
5578 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5579 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5580 @end deffn
5581
5582 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5583 @cindex kinetis
5584 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
5585 from NXP (former Freescale) include
5586 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5587 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5588 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5589 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
5590
5591 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
5592 @itemize
5593 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
5594 @end itemize
5595
5596 @example
5597 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5598 @end example
5599
5600 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
5601 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
5602 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
5603 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
5604 @end deffn
5605
5606 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5607 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5608 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5609 set by 'flash protect' command.
5610 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5611 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5612 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5613 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5614 with the rest of a flash image.
5615 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5616 @end deffn
5617
5618 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5619 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5620 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5621 @end deffn
5622
5623 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5624 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5625 @end deffn
5626
5627 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5628 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5629 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5630 @end deffn
5631
5632 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5633 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5634 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5635 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5636 command completes.
5637 @end deffn
5638
5639 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5640 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5641 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5642 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5643 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5644
5645 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5646 Program Partition command.
5647
5648 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5649 Reset the device after partition setting.
5650
5651 Show partition size:
5652 @example
5653 kinetis nvm_partition info
5654 @end example
5655
5656 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5657 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5658 @example
5659 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5660 @end example
5661
5662 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5663 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5664 @example
5665 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5666 @end example
5667 @end deffn
5668
5669 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
5670 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
5671 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
5672 @end deffn
5673
5674 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5675 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5676 Command disables watchdog timer.
5677 @end deffn
5678 @end deffn
5679
5680 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5681 @cindex kinetis_ke
5682 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
5683 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5684 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5685 autoconfigures itself.
5686 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
5687
5688 @example
5689 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5690 @end example
5691
5692 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5693 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5694 @end deffn
5695
5696 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5697 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5698 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5699 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5700 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5701 @end deffn
5702
5703 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5704 Command disables watchdog timer.
5705 @end deffn
5706 @end deffn
5707
5708 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5709 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5710 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5711 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5712 microcontroller families from NXP.
5713
5714 @quotation Note
5715 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5716 driver:
5717 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5718 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5719 @end quotation
5720
5721 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5722 which must appear in the following order:
5723
5724 @itemize
5725 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5726 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5727 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5728 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5729 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5730 LPC43x[2357])
5731 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5732 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5733 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5734 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5735 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5736 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5737 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5738 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5739 at which the core is running
5740 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5741 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5742 @quotation Note
5743 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5744 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5745 However, if you do provide it,
5746 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5747 @end quotation
5748 @end itemize
5749
5750 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5751
5752 @example
5753 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5754 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5755 @end example
5756
5757 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5758 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5759 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5760 @end deffn
5761 @end deffn
5762
5763 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5764 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5765 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5766 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5767 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5768 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5769
5770 @example
5771 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5772 @end example
5773 @end deffn
5774
5775 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5776 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5777 from NXP.
5778
5779 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5780 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5781 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5782 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5783 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5784 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5785 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5786 you start the PLL.
5787
5788 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5789
5790 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5791 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5792 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5793
5794 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5795 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5796 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5797 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5798 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5799 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5800 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5801
5802 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5803 @example
5804 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5805 @end example
5806
5807 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5808 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5809 @code{flash banks} command.
5810
5811 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5812 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5813 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5814 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5815 a known signature.
5816 Example:
5817 @example
5818 lpc2900 signature 0
5819 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5820 @end example
5821 @end deffn
5822
5823 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5824 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5825 saves it to a file in binary format.
5826 Example:
5827 @example
5828 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5829 @end example
5830 @end deffn
5831
5832 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5833 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5834 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5835 command:
5836
5837 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5838 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5839 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5840 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5841
5842 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5843 Example:
5844 @example
5845 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5846 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5847 @end example
5848 @end deffn
5849
5850 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5851 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5852 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5853 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5854 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5855 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5856 912 bytes.
5857 @quotation Attention
5858 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5859 @end quotation
5860 Example:
5861 @example
5862 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5863 @end example
5864 @end deffn
5865
5866 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5867 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5868 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5869 after the next power cycle.
5870 @quotation Attention
5871 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5872 @end quotation
5873 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5874 Example:
5875 @example
5876 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5877 flash info 0
5878 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5879 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5880 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5881 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5882 @end example
5883 @end deffn
5884
5885 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5886 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5887 effective after the next power cycle.
5888 @quotation Attention
5889 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5890 @end quotation
5891 Examples:
5892 @example
5893 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5894 @end example
5895 @end deffn
5896 @end deffn
5897
5898 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5899 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5900 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5901 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5902
5903 @example
5904 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5905 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5906 @end example
5907
5908 @itemize @bullet
5909 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5910 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5911 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5912 @end itemize
5913
5914 Example usage:
5915 @example
5916 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5917 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5918 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5919 @} else @{
5920 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5921 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5922 @}
5923 @end example
5924 @end deffn
5925
5926 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
5927 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
5928 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5929 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
5930 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
5931 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
5932 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
5933 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
5934 also have division into regions: main and info.
5935 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
5936 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memmory.
5937
5938 @example
5939 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5940 @end example
5941
5942 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
5943
5944 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
5945 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
5946 @end deffn
5947
5948 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
5949 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
5950 @end deffn
5951
5952 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
5953 Erase all userflash including info region.
5954 @end deffn
5955
5956 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
5957 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5958 @end deffn
5959
5960 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
5961 Check sectors protect.
5962 @end deffn
5963
5964 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
5965 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5966 @end deffn
5967
5968 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
5969 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
5970 @end deffn
5971
5972 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
5973 Configure external memory interface for boot.
5974 @end deffn
5975
5976 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
5977 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
5978 @end deffn
5979
5980 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
5981 Show information about flash driver.
5982 @end deffn
5983
5984 @end deffn
5985
5986 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
5987 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5988 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5989 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
5990 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
5991
5992 @example
5993 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5994 @end example
5995
5996 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
5997
5998 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
5999 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6000 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6001 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6002 code.
6003 @end deffn
6004
6005 @end deffn
6006
6007 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6008 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6009 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6010
6011 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6012 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6013 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6014 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6015
6016 @example
6017 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6018 @end example
6019 @end deffn
6020
6021 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6022 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6023 and integrate flash memory.
6024
6025 @example
6026 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6027 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6028 @end example
6029
6030 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6031 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6032 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6033 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6034 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6035 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6036 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6037 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6038 @end deffn
6039 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6040 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6041 This will remove any Code Protection.
6042 @end deffn
6043 @end deffn
6044
6045 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6046 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6047 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6048 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6049 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6050
6051 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6052 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6053
6054 @example
6055 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6056 @end example
6057
6058 psoc4-specific commands
6059 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6060 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6061
6062 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6063 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6064
6065 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6066 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6067 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6068
6069 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6070 @end deffn
6071
6072 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6073 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6074
6075 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6076 @end deffn
6077 @end deffn
6078
6079 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6080 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6081 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6082 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6083
6084 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6085 @itemize @bullet
6086 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6087 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6088 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6089 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6090 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6091 row size: 512 bytes.
6092 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6093 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6094 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6095 operation will erase row automatically.
6096 @end itemize
6097
6098 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6099 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6100
6101 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6102
6103 @example
6104 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6105 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6106 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6107 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6108 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6109 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6110
6111 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6112 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6113 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6114 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6115 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6116 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6117 @end example
6118
6119 psoc6-specific commands
6120 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6121 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6122 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6123 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6124 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6125 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6126 @end deffn
6127
6128 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6129 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6130 by @command{flash banks}.
6131 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6132 @end deffn
6133 @end deffn
6134
6135 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6136 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6137 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6138 and SWD interface.
6139 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6140 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6141
6142 @example
6143 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6144 @end example
6145
6146 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6147
6148 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6149 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6150 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6151 @end deffn
6152
6153 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6154 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6155 @end deffn
6156 @end deffn
6157
6158 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6159 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6160 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6161 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6162 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6163
6164 @example
6165 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6166 @end example
6167
6168 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6169 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6170 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6171 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6172 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6173 disabled.
6174
6175 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6176 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6177 @quotation Warning
6178 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6179 applied to all of them.
6180 @end quotation
6181 @end deffn
6182 @end deffn
6183
6184 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6185 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6186 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6187 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6188 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6189
6190 @example
6191 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6192 @end example
6193
6194 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6195 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6196 the flash driver.
6197
6198 @example
6199 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6200 @end example
6201
6202 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6203 as per the following example.
6204 @example
6205 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6206 @end example
6207
6208 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6209
6210 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6211 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6212 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6213 @end deffn
6214
6215 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6216 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6217 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6218 @end deffn
6219
6220 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6221 Mass erases the entire stm32f1x device.
6222 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6223 @end deffn
6224
6225 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6226 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
6227 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
6228 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6229 @end deffn
6230
6231 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
6232 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6233 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6234 @end deffn
6235 @end deffn
6236
6237 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6238 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6239 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6240 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6241 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6242
6243 @example
6244 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6245 @end example
6246
6247 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6248 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6249 the flash driver.
6250
6251 @example
6252 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6253 @end example
6254
6255 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6256
6257 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6258 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6259 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6260 @end deffn
6261
6262 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6263 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6264 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6265 @end deffn
6266
6267 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6268 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6269 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6270 @end deffn
6271
6272 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6273 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6274 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6275 @end deffn
6276
6277 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6278 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6279 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6280 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6281 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6282 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6283 @end deffn
6284
6285 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6286 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6287 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6288 @end deffn
6289 @end deffn
6290
6291 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6292 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6293 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6294 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6295 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6296
6297 @example
6298 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6299 @end example
6300
6301 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6302 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6303 the flash driver.
6304
6305 @example
6306 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6307 @end example
6308
6309 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6310
6311 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6312 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6313 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6314 @end deffn
6315
6316 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6317 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6318 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6319 @end deffn
6320
6321 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6322 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6323 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6324 @end deffn
6325 @end deffn
6326
6327 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6328 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6329 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6330 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6331 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6332
6333 @example
6334 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6335 @end example
6336
6337 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6338 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6339 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6340 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6341 second bank.
6342
6343 @example
6344 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6345 @end example
6346
6347 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6348
6349 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6350 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6351 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6352 @end deffn
6353
6354 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6355 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6356 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6357 @end deffn
6358
6359 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6360 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6361 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6362 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6363 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6364 @end deffn
6365 @end deffn
6366
6367 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6368 All members of the STM32L4 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6369 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6370 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6371 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6372
6373 @example
6374 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6375 @end example
6376
6377 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6378 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6379 the flash driver.
6380
6381 @example
6382 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6383 @end example
6384
6385 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6386
6387 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6388 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6389 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6390 @end deffn
6391
6392 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6393 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6394 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6395 @end deffn
6396
6397 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6398 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6399 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6400 @end deffn
6401 @end deffn
6402
6403 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
6404 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
6405 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6406 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
6407 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
6408
6409 @example
6410 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
6411 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
6412 @end example
6413
6414 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
6415 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
6416 for the specified flash bank.
6417 @end deffn
6418 @end deffn
6419
6420 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
6421 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
6422 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
6423 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
6424 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
6425
6426 @example
6427 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6428 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
6429 @end example
6430
6431 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
6432 Configures the str9 flash controller.
6433 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6434
6435 @itemize @bullet
6436 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
6437 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
6438 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6439 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6440 @end itemize
6441 @end deffn
6442
6443 @end deffn
6444
6445 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
6446 @cindex str9xpec
6447
6448 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
6449 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
6450 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
6451 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
6452
6453 Here is some background info to help
6454 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
6455 the str9:
6456 @enumerate
6457 @item
6458 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
6459 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
6460 @item
6461 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
6462 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
6463 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
6464 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
6465 @end enumerate
6466
6467 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
6468 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
6469 configured for flash bank 0.
6470 @example
6471 # assert srst, we do not want core running
6472 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
6473 jtag_reset 0 1
6474 # turn off target polling
6475 poll off
6476 # disable str9 core
6477 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
6478 # read option bytes
6479 str9xpec options_read 0
6480 # re-enable str9 core
6481 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
6482 poll on
6483 reset halt
6484 @end example
6485 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
6486 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
6487 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
6488 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
6489
6490 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
6491
6492 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
6493 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
6494 @end deffn
6495
6496 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
6497 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
6498 directly to the embedded flash controller.
6499 @end deffn
6500
6501 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
6502 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
6503 erase the device.
6504 @end deffn
6505
6506 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
6507 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
6508 @end deffn
6509
6510 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
6511 Configure str9 boot bank.
6512 @end deffn
6513
6514 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6515 Configure str9 lvd source.
6516 @end deffn
6517
6518 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
6519 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
6520 @end deffn
6521
6522 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6523 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
6524 @end deffn
6525
6526 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
6527 Read str9 option bytes.
6528 @end deffn
6529
6530 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
6531 Write str9 option bytes.
6532 @end deffn
6533
6534 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
6535 unlock str9 device.
6536 @end deffn
6537
6538 @end deffn
6539
6540 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
6541 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
6542 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6543 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6544
6545 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
6546
6547 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
6548 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
6549 @end deffn
6550
6551 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
6552 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
6553 @end deffn
6554
6555 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
6556 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
6557 the flash clock.
6558 @end deffn
6559 @end deffn
6560
6561 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
6562 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6563 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6564 @end deffn
6565
6566 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
6567 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6568 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6569
6570 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
6571
6572 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
6573 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
6574 @end deffn
6575
6576 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
6577 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
6578 @end deffn
6579
6580 @end deffn
6581
6582 @section NAND Flash Commands
6583 @cindex NAND
6584
6585 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
6586 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
6587 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
6588
6589 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
6590 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
6591 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
6592 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
6593 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
6594 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
6595
6596 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
6597 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
6598 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
6599 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
6600 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
6601 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
6602 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
6603 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
6604 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
6605 with techniques such as wear leveling.
6606
6607 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
6608 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
6609 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
6610 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
6611 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
6612 every 512 bytes of data.
6613
6614 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
6615 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
6616 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
6617 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
6618 ECC mode is used.
6619
6620 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
6621 @enumerate
6622 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
6623 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
6624 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
6625 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
6626 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
6627 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
6628 to access that device.
6629 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
6630 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
6631 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
6632 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
6633 de-brick a board.
6634 @end enumerate
6635
6636 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
6637 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
6638 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
6639 are only 32 bits wide.
6640 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
6641 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
6642 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
6643 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
6644
6645 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
6646 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
6647 @cindex NAND configuration
6648
6649 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
6650 plus some additional configuration that's done after
6651 OpenOCD has initialized.
6652
6653 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
6654 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
6655 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
6656 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
6657 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
6658 they were a single (larger) device.
6659 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
6660 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
6661
6662 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
6663 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
6664 configuration files, not interactively.
6665
6666 @itemize @bullet
6667 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
6668 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
6669 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
6670 associated with the NAND device being declared.
6671 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
6672 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
6673 commands to the NAND controller.
6674 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
6675 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
6676 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
6677 for more information.
6678 @end itemize
6679 @end deffn
6680
6681 @deffn Command {nand list}
6682 Prints a summary of each device declared
6683 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
6684 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
6685 @example
6686 > nand list
6687 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6688 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6689 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6690 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6691 >
6692 @end example
6693 @end deffn
6694
6695 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
6696 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
6697 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
6698 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6699 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
6700 it with most other NAND commands.
6701 @end deffn
6702
6703 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
6704
6705 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
6706 @cindex NAND reading
6707 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
6708 starting at the specified offset.
6709 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6710
6711 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6712 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6713
6714 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
6715 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
6716 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
6717
6718 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
6719 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
6720 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
6721 method which handled that error correction.
6722
6723 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
6724 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
6725 @itemize @bullet
6726 @item no oob_* parameter
6727 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
6728 @item @code{oob_raw}
6729 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
6730 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
6731 spare areas associated with each data page.
6732 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
6733 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
6734 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
6735 @item @code{oob_only}
6736 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
6737 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
6738 spare areas associated with each data page.
6739 @end itemize
6740 @end deffn
6741
6742 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
6743 @cindex NAND erasing
6744 @cindex NAND programming
6745 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
6746 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
6747 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6748 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6749 If those parameters are not specified,
6750 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
6751 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6752
6753 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
6754 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
6755 block marker.
6756 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
6757 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
6758 @end deffn
6759
6760 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
6761 @cindex NAND writing
6762 @cindex NAND programming
6763 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
6764 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
6765 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
6766 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6767
6768 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6769 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6770
6771 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6772 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
6773 past the end of the device.
6774 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
6775 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
6776 if that's being written.)
6777
6778 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
6779 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
6780 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
6781
6782 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
6783 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
6784 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
6785 @itemize @bullet
6786 @item no oob_* parameter
6787 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6788 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
6789 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6790 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
6791 with hardware-computed ECC data.
6792 @item @code{oob_only}
6793 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
6794 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
6795 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
6796 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
6797 @item @code{oob_raw}
6798 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
6799 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
6800 un-altered OOB.
6801 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6802 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
6803 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
6804 @item @code{oob_softecc}
6805 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6806 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
6807 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
6808 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6809 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6810 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6811 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6812 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6813 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6814 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6815 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6816 @end itemize
6817 @end deffn
6818
6819 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6820 @cindex NAND verification
6821 @cindex NAND programming
6822 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6823 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6824 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6825
6826 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6827 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6828
6829 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6830 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6831 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6832 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6833 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6834
6835 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6836 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6837 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6838
6839 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6840 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6841 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6842 be removed in a future release.
6843 @end deffn
6844
6845 @subsection Other NAND commands
6846 @cindex NAND other commands
6847
6848 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6849 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6850 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6851 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6852 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6853 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6854 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6855 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6856
6857 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6858 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6859 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6860 @end deffn
6861
6862 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6863 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6864 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6865 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6866 status for each block.
6867 @end deffn
6868
6869 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6870 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6871 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6872
6873 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6874 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6875 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6876 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6877 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6878
6879 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6880 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6881 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6882 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6883 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6884 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6885 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6886 @end deffn
6887
6888 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6889 @subsection NAND Driver List
6890 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6891 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6892 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6893
6894 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6895 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6896 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6897 address of the ECC controller.
6898 @example
6899 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6900 @end example
6901 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6902 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6903 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6904 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6905 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6906 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6907 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6908 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6909 @end deffn
6910 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6911 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6912 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6913 @end deffn
6914
6915 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6916 properly configured for input or output.
6917 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6918 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6919 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6920 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6921 @end deffn
6922 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6923 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6924 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6925 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6926 @end deffn
6927 @end deffn
6928
6929 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6930 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6931 chips from Texas Instruments.
6932 It takes three extra parameters:
6933 address of the NAND chip;
6934 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6935 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6936 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6937 @example
6938 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6939 @end example
6940 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6941 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6942 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6943 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6944 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6945 @end deffn
6946
6947 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6948 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6949 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6950 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6951 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6952 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6953 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6954 @end deffn
6955
6956 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6957 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6958 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6959 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6960 @end deffn
6961 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6962
6963 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6964 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6965 should work for this chip aswell.
6966 @end deffn
6967
6968 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6969 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6970 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6971 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6972 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6973 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6974 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6975 @example
6976 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6977 @end example
6978 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6979 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6980 without parameter query status.
6981 @end deffn
6982 @end deffn
6983
6984 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6985 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6986 parameter: the address of the controller.
6987 @example
6988 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6989 @end example
6990 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6991 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6992 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6993 change any behavior.
6994 @end deffn
6995
6996 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6997 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6998 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6999 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7000 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7001 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7002 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7003 specialized commands.
7004 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7005 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7006 change any behavior.
7007 @end deffn
7008
7009 @section mFlash
7010
7011 @subsection mFlash Configuration
7012 @cindex mFlash Configuration
7013
7014 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
7015 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
7016 address @var{base}.
7017 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
7018 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
7019
7020 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
7021
7022 @example
7023 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
7024 @end example
7025
7026 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
7027
7028 @example
7029 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
7030 @end example
7031 @end deffn
7032
7033 @subsection mFlash commands
7034 @cindex mFlash commands
7035
7036 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
7037 Configure mflash PLL.
7038 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
7039 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
7040 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
7041 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
7042 @end deffn
7043
7044 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
7045 Configure bootable option.
7046 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
7047 (4kB) for boot.
7048 @end deffn
7049
7050 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
7051 Configure storage information.
7052 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
7053 written.
7054 @end deffn
7055
7056 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
7057 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
7058 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
7059 @end deffn
7060
7061 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
7062 Probe mflash.
7063 @end deffn
7064
7065 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
7066 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
7067 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
7068 @end deffn
7069
7070 @node Flash Programming
7071 @chapter Flash Programming
7072
7073 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7074 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7075 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7076
7077 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7078 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7079
7080 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
7081 @enumerate
7082 @item 'init' is executed.
7083 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7084 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7085 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7086 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7087 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7088 @end enumerate
7089
7090 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7091
7092 @example
7093 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7094 # are optional parameters
7095 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7096 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7097
7098 # binary files need the flash address passing
7099 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7100 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7101 @end example
7102
7103 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7104 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7105 @cindex PLD
7106 @cindex FPGA
7107
7108 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7109 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7110 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7111 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7112 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7113 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7114 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7115
7116 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7117
7118 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7119 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7120 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7121
7122 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7123 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7124
7125 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7126 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7127 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7128 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7129 behavior.
7130 @end deffn
7131
7132 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7133 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7134 @end deffn
7135
7136 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7137 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7138 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7139 @end deffn
7140
7141 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7142
7143 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7144 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7145 that particular type of PLD.
7146
7147 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7148 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7149 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7150
7151 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7152 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7153 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7154
7155 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7156 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7157 for FPGA @var{num}.
7158 @end deffn
7159 @end deffn
7160
7161 @node General Commands
7162 @chapter General Commands
7163 @cindex commands
7164
7165 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7166 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7167 commands are documented elsewhere.
7168
7169 Intent:
7170 @itemize @bullet
7171 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7172 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7173 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
7174 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7175
7176 @item @b{From the human}
7177 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7178 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7179
7180 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7181 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7182 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7183
7184 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7185 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7186 port is 5555.
7187 @end itemize
7188
7189
7190 @section Server Commands
7191
7192 @deffn {Command} exit
7193 Exits the current telnet session.
7194 @end deffn
7195
7196 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7197 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7198 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7199 Not every command provides helptext.
7200
7201 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7202 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7203 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7204 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7205 @end deffn
7206
7207 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7208 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7209 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7210 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7211 Useful in connection with script files
7212 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7213 @end deffn
7214
7215 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7216 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7217 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7218 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7219 @end deffn
7220
7221 @anchor{debuglevel}
7222 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7223 @cindex message level
7224 Display debug level.
7225 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7226 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7227 Level 0 is error messages only;
7228 level 1 adds warnings;
7229 level 2 adds informational messages;
7230 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7231 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7232 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7233 the command line along with the location of that log
7234 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7235 @xref{Running}.
7236 @end deffn
7237
7238 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7239 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7240 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7241 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7242 @example
7243 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7244 @end example
7245 @end deffn
7246
7247 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
7248 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
7249 the initial log output channel is stderr.
7250 @end deffn
7251
7252 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7253 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7254 @end deffn
7255
7256 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7257 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7258 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7259 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7260 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7261 @end deffn
7262
7263 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7264 @section Target State handling
7265 @cindex reset
7266 @cindex halt
7267 @cindex target initialization
7268
7269 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7270 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7271 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7272 a current target which is used to perform the
7273 various operations. The current target may be changed
7274 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7275 target which should become current.
7276
7277 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7278 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7279 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7280 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7281 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7282
7283 @emph{With no arguments}:
7284 list all available registers for the current target,
7285 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7286 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7287 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7288 are flagged as such.
7289
7290 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7291 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7292 bypassing any internal cache.
7293
7294 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7295 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7296 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7297 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7298 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7299 relevant module will flush such values.
7300
7301 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7302 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7303
7304 @example
7305 > reg
7306 ===== ARM registers
7307 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7308 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7309 (2) r2 (/32)
7310 ...
7311 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7312 >
7313 @end example
7314 @end deffn
7315
7316 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7317 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7318 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7319 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7320 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7321 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7322 (and enter debug mode).
7323 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7324
7325 @quotation Warning
7326 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7327 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7328 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7329 power mode by gating the core clock;
7330 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7331
7332 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7333 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7334 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7335 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7336 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7337 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7338
7339 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7340 work with a JTAG debugger.
7341 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
7342 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7343 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7344 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7345 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7346 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7347 @end quotation
7348
7349 @end deffn
7350
7351 @deffn Command resume [address]
7352 Resume the target at its current code position,
7353 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7354 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7355 @end deffn
7356
7357 @deffn Command step [address]
7358 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7359 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7360 @end deffn
7361
7362 @anchor{resetcommand}
7363 @deffn Command reset
7364 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7365 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7366 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7367 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7368 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7369 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7370
7371 The optional parameter specifies what should
7372 happen after the reset.
7373 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7374 The other options will not work on all systems.
7375 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7376
7377 @itemize @minus
7378 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7379 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7380 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7381 @end itemize
7382 @end deffn
7383
7384 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7385 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7386 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
7387 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
7388 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
7389 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
7390 state.
7391 @end deffn
7392
7393 @section I/O Utilities
7394
7395 These commands are available when
7396 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
7397 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
7398 notably the ZY1000.
7399 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
7400
7401 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
7402
7403 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
7404 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
7405 the text file @file{filename}.
7406 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
7407 The last string is followed by a newline.
7408 @end deffn
7409
7410 @deffn Command cat filename
7411 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
7412 @end deffn
7413
7414 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
7415 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
7416 into @file{dest_filename}.
7417 @end deffn
7418
7419 @deffn Command ip
7420 @emph{No description provided.}
7421 @end deffn
7422
7423 @deffn Command ls
7424 @emph{No description provided.}
7425 @end deffn
7426
7427 @deffn Command mac
7428 @emph{No description provided.}
7429 @end deffn
7430
7431 @deffn Command meminfo
7432 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
7433 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
7434 @end deffn
7435
7436 @deffn Command peek
7437 @emph{No description provided.}
7438 @end deffn
7439
7440 @deffn Command poke
7441 @emph{No description provided.}
7442 @end deffn
7443
7444 @deffn Command rm filename
7445 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
7446 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
7447 @end deffn
7448
7449 @deffn Command trunc filename
7450 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
7451 @end deffn
7452
7453 @anchor{memoryaccess}
7454 @section Memory access commands
7455 @cindex memory access
7456
7457 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
7458 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
7459 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
7460 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
7461
7462 @enumerate
7463 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
7464 to change the current target.
7465 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
7466 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
7467 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
7468 @end enumerate
7469
7470 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
7471 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
7472 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
7473 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
7474 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
7475 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
7476 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7477 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7478 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7479 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7480 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
7481 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
7482 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
7483 @end deffn
7484
7485 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
7486 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
7487 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
7488 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
7489 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
7490 at the specified address @var{addr}.
7491 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7492 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7493 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7494 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7495 @end deffn
7496
7497 @anchor{imageaccess}
7498 @section Image loading commands
7499 @cindex image loading
7500 @cindex image dumping
7501
7502 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
7503 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
7504 binary file named @var{filename}.
7505 @end deffn
7506
7507 @deffn Command {fast_load}
7508 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
7509 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
7510 @end deffn
7511
7512 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
7513 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
7514 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
7515 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
7516 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
7517 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
7518 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
7519 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
7520 separately.
7521 @end deffn
7522
7523 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
7524 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
7525 The file format may optionally be specified
7526 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
7527 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
7528 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
7529 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
7530 @example
7531 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
7532 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
7533 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
7534 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
7535 $address $length
7536 @}
7537 @end example
7538 @end deffn
7539
7540 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
7541 Displays image section sizes and addresses
7542 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
7543 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
7544 The file format may optionally be specified
7545 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7546 @end deffn
7547
7548 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7549 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7550 The file format may optionally be specified
7551 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7552 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
7553 @end deffn
7554
7555 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7556 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7557 The file format may optionally be specified
7558 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7559 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
7560 @end deffn
7561
7562
7563 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
7564 @cindex breakpoint
7565 @cindex watchpoint
7566
7567 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
7568 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
7569 watchpoints.
7570 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
7571
7572 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
7573 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
7574 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
7575 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7576 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
7577 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
7578
7579 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
7580 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
7581 @end deffn
7582
7583 @deffn Command {rbp} address
7584 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
7585 @end deffn
7586
7587 @deffn Command {rwp} address
7588 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
7589 @end deffn
7590
7591 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
7592 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
7593 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7594 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
7595 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
7596 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
7597 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
7598 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
7599 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
7600 @end deffn
7601
7602 @section Misc Commands
7603
7604 @cindex profiling
7605 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
7606 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
7607 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
7608 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
7609 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
7610 limit the address range.
7611 @end deffn
7612
7613 @deffn Command {version}
7614 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
7615 @end deffn
7616
7617 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
7618 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
7619 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
7620 @end deffn
7621
7622 @node Architecture and Core Commands
7623 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
7624 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
7625 @cindex Core Specific Commands
7626
7627 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
7628 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
7629 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
7630 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
7631
7632 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
7633 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
7634 @cindex tracing
7635 @cindex ETM
7636 @cindex ETB
7637
7638 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
7639 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
7640 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
7641
7642 @itemize
7643 @item
7644 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
7645 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
7646 supports such an interface.
7647 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
7648 and trace port support.)
7649 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
7650 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
7651 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
7652 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
7653 in the board-specific configuration file.
7654 @item
7655 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
7656 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
7657 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
7658 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
7659 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
7660 @end itemize
7661
7662 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
7663
7664 @quotation Issues
7665 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
7666 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
7667
7668 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
7669 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
7670 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
7671 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
7672 dummy trace port driver}.
7673
7674 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
7675 as well as tracing only during specific states
7676 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
7677
7678 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
7679 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
7680 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
7681 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
7682 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
7683
7684 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
7685 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
7686 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
7687 this original style of JTAG access.
7688 @end quotation
7689
7690 @subsection ETM Configuration
7691 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
7692
7693 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
7694 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
7695 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
7696
7697 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
7698 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
7699 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
7700 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
7701 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
7702 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
7703 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
7704 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
7705 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
7706
7707 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
7708 or @option{demultiplexed}.
7709 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
7710
7711 @quotation Warning
7712 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
7713 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
7714 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
7715 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
7716 @end quotation
7717
7718 @quotation Note
7719 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
7720 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
7721 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
7722 what CPU activities are traced.
7723 @end quotation
7724 @end deffn
7725
7726 @deffn Command {etm info}
7727 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
7728 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
7729 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
7730 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
7731 @end deffn
7732
7733 @deffn Command {etm status}
7734 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
7735 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
7736 Did trace data overflow?
7737 Was it triggered?
7738 @end deffn
7739
7740 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
7741 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
7742 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
7743 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
7744 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
7745
7746 @itemize
7747 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
7748 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
7749 The value is one of
7750 @option{none} (save nothing),
7751 @option{data} (save data),
7752 @option{address} (save addresses),
7753 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
7754 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
7755 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
7756 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
7757 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
7758 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
7759 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
7760 trace stream without an image of the code.
7761 @end itemize
7762 @end deffn
7763
7764 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7765 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
7766 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
7767 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
7768 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
7769
7770 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
7771 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
7772 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
7773 @end deffn
7774
7775 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
7776
7777 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
7778 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
7779 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
7780
7781 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
7782 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
7783 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
7784 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
7785 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
7786 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
7787 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
7788
7789 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
7790
7791 @itemize
7792 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
7793 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
7794 for instruction access within that function's body.
7795 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
7796 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
7797 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
7798 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
7799 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
7800 combining one of the above models with a counter.
7801 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
7802 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
7803 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
7804 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
7805 @item @emph{... more}
7806 @end itemize
7807
7808 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
7809 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
7810
7811 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
7812 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
7813 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
7814 @end deffn
7815
7816 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
7817 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
7818 @end deffn
7819
7820 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
7821 Opens an image file.
7822 @end deffn
7823
7824 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
7825 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
7826 @end deffn
7827
7828 @deffn Command {etm start}
7829 Starts trace data collection.
7830 @end deffn
7831
7832 @deffn Command {etm stop}
7833 Stops trace data collection.
7834 @end deffn
7835
7836 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
7837 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
7838
7839 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
7840
7841 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
7842 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7843 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
7844 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
7845 any trace data collection.}
7846 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
7847 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
7848 @end deffn
7849 @end deffn
7850
7851 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
7852 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
7853 to use on-chip ETB memory.
7854 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
7855 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
7856 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
7857 @end deffn
7858 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
7859 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
7860 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
7861 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
7862 trace trigger becomes active.
7863
7864 @itemize
7865 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
7866 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
7867 afterwards.
7868 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
7869 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
7870 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
7871 what caused that event to happen.
7872 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
7873 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
7874 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
7875 how the event caused trouble.
7876 @end itemize
7877 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
7878 @end deffn
7879
7880 @end deffn
7881
7882 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
7883 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
7884 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
7885 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
7886 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
7887
7888 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7889 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
7890
7891 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
7892 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
7893 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
7894 @end deffn
7895
7896 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7897 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7898 @end deffn
7899
7900 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7901 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7902 @end deffn
7903 @end deffn
7904
7905 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
7906 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
7907 @cindex CTI
7908
7909 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
7910 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
7911 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
7912 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
7913 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
7914 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
7915
7916 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
7917 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
7918 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
7919 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
7920 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
7921 including additional configuration.
7922 @end deffn
7923
7924 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
7925 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
7926 @end deffn
7927
7928 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
7929 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
7930 @end deffn
7931
7932 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
7933 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
7934 @end deffn
7935
7936 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
7937 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
7938 @end deffn
7939
7940 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
7941 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
7942 of the CTI.
7943 @end deffn
7944
7945 @deffn Command {cti names}
7946 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
7947 useful in TCL scripting.
7948 @end deffn
7949
7950 @section Generic ARM
7951 @cindex ARM
7952
7953 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7954 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7955 commands that may be available.
7956
7957 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7958 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7959 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7960 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7961 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7962 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7963 @end deffn
7964
7965 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7966 @cindex disassemble
7967 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7968 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7969 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7970 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7971 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7972 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7973 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7974
7975 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7976 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7977 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7978 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7979 with a handful of exceptions.
7980 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7981 @end deffn
7982
7983 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7984 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7985 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7986 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7987 and using the MCR instruction.
7988 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7989 an ARM register.)
7990 @end deffn
7991
7992 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7993 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7994 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7995 and the MRC instruction.
7996 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7997 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7998 an ARM register.)
7999 @end deffn
8000
8001 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8002 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8003 core mode if necessary.
8004 @end deffn
8005
8006 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8007 @cindex ARM semihosting
8008 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8009
8010 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8011 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8012 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8013 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8014 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8015 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8016 @end deffn
8017
8018 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8019 @cindex ARM semihosting
8020 Set the command line to be passed to the debuggee.
8021
8022 @example
8023 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8024 @end example
8025
8026 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8027 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8028 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8029 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8030 @end deffn
8031
8032 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8033 @cindex ARM semihosting
8034 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8035 status.
8036
8037 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8038 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8039 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8040 debugger.
8041 @end deffn
8042
8043 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8044 @cindex ARMv4
8045 @cindex ARMv5
8046
8047 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8048 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8049 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8050 variant.
8051
8052 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8053 @cindex ARM7
8054 @cindex ARM9
8055
8056 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8057 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8058 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8059 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8060
8061 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8062 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8063 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8064 instead of breakpoints.
8065 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8066
8067 This should be
8068 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8069 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8070 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8071 @end deffn
8072
8073 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8074 @cindex DCC
8075 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8076 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8077 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8078
8079 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8080 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8081 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8082 @end deffn
8083
8084 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8085 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8086 that don't check completion of the operation.
8087 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8088
8089 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8090 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8091 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8092 @end deffn
8093
8094 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8095 @cindex ARM720T
8096
8097 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8098 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8099 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8100 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8101
8102 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8103 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8104 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8105
8106 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8107 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8108 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8109 @end deffn
8110
8111 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8112 @cindex ARM9
8113
8114 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8115 integer processors.
8116 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8117
8118 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8119 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8120 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8121 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8122
8123 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8124 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8125 @cindex vector_catch
8126 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8127 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8128 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8129 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8130 to those hardware vectors.
8131
8132 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8133 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8134 vector catch hardware to intercept
8135 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8136 @option{none} of them,
8137 or a list with one or more of the following:
8138 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8139 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8140 @end deffn
8141
8142 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8143 @cindex ARM920T
8144
8145 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8146 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8147 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8148 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8149 and ARM9 commands.
8150
8151 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8152 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8153 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8154 @end deffn
8155
8156 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8157 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8158 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8159 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8160 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8161 (Not all registers can be written.)
8162 @end deffn
8163
8164 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8165 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8166 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8167
8168 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8169 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8170 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8171 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8172 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8173 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8174 @end deffn
8175
8176 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8177 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8178 @end deffn
8179
8180 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8181 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8182 @end deffn
8183
8184 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8185 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8186
8187 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8188 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8189 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8190 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8191 and ARM9 commands.
8192
8193 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8194 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8195
8196 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8197 Print information about the caches found.
8198 @end deffn
8199
8200 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8201 @cindex ARM966E
8202
8203 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8204 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8205 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8206 and ARM9 commands.
8207
8208 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8209 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8210 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8211 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8212 ARM966E-S TRM.
8213 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8214 as required for BIST support.
8215 @end deffn
8216
8217 @subsection XScale specific commands
8218 @cindex XScale
8219
8220 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8221
8222 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8223 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8224 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8225 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8226 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8227 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8228 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8229
8230 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8231 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
8232 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8233 the mini-IC.
8234
8235 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8236 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8237 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8238 code layout in memory:
8239 @example
8240 _vectors:
8241 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8242 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8243 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8244 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8245 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8246 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8247 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8248 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8249 .org 0x100
8250 .long real_reset_vector
8251 .long real_ui_handler
8252 .long real_swi_handler
8253 .long real_pf_abort
8254 .long real_data_abort
8255 .long 0 /* unused */
8256 .long real_irq_handler
8257 .long real_fiq_handler
8258 @end example
8259
8260 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8261 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8262 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8263 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8264 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8265 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8266 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8267 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8268 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8269 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8270 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8271 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8272 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8273 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8274 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8275 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8276 software.
8277
8278 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8279 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8280 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8281 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8282
8283 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8284 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8285 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8286 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8287 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8288 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8289 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8290 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8291 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8292
8293 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8294 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8295
8296 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8297 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8298 @end deffn
8299
8300 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8301 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8302 @end deffn
8303
8304 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8305 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8306 @end deffn
8307
8308 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8309 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8310 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8311 @end deffn
8312
8313 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
8314 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
8315 @end deffn
8316
8317 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8318 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
8319 @end deffn
8320
8321 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
8322 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
8323 @end deffn
8324
8325 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8326 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
8327 @end deffn
8328
8329 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8330 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
8331 @end deffn
8332
8333 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
8334 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
8335 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
8336 and modifying how it is emptied.
8337 @end deffn
8338
8339 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
8340 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
8341 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
8342 The image @var{type} may be one of
8343 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
8344 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
8345 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
8346 @end deffn
8347
8348 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
8349 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
8350 @cindex vector_catch
8351 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
8352 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
8353
8354 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
8355 @example
8356 0x01 Trap Reset
8357 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
8358 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
8359 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
8360 0x10 Trap Data Abort
8361 0x20 reserved
8362 0x40 Trap IRQ
8363 0x80 Trap FIQ
8364 @end example
8365 @end deffn
8366
8367 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
8368 @cindex vector_table
8369
8370 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
8371 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
8372 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
8373 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
8374 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
8375
8376 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
8377
8378 @end deffn
8379
8380 @section ARMv6 Architecture
8381 @cindex ARMv6
8382
8383 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
8384 @cindex ARM11
8385
8386 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8387 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
8388 which is enabled by default.
8389 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8390 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
8391 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
8392 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
8393 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
8394 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
8395 @end deffn
8396
8397 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8398 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
8399 which is enabled by default.
8400 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8401 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
8402 @end deffn
8403
8404 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8405 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
8406 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
8407 they are disabled by default.
8408 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
8409 @end deffn
8410
8411 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
8412 @cindex vector_catch
8413 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
8414 coprocessor 14 register 7.
8415 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
8416
8417 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8418 for certain hardware events.
8419 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
8420 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
8421 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
8422 @end deffn
8423
8424 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
8425 @cindex ARMv7
8426 @cindex ARMv8
8427
8428 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
8429 @cindex Cortex-A
8430
8431 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
8432 display information about target caches
8433 @end deffn
8434
8435 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
8436 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
8437 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
8438 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
8439 Defaults to 'off'.
8440 @end deffn
8441
8442 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
8443 Initialize core debug
8444 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8445 @end deffn
8446
8447 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
8448 Disable SMP mode
8449 @end deffn
8450
8451 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
8452 Enable SMP mode
8453 @end deffn
8454
8455 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
8456 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
8457 @end deffn
8458
8459 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8460 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8461 @end deffn
8462
8463 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
8464 configure l2x cache
8465 @end deffn
8466
8467
8468 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
8469 @cindex Cortex-R
8470
8471 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
8472 Initialize core debug
8473 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8474 @end deffn
8475
8476 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8477 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8478 @end deffn
8479
8480
8481 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
8482 @cindex tracing
8483 @cindex SWO
8484 @cindex SWV
8485 @cindex TPIU
8486 @cindex ITM
8487 @cindex ETM
8488
8489 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
8490 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
8491 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
8492
8493 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
8494 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
8495 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
8496 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
8497
8498 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
8499 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
8500 debugger adapter features.
8501
8502 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
8503 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
8504
8505 Command options:
8506 @itemize @minus
8507 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
8508 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
8509 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
8510 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8511 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
8512 either a regular file or a named pipe);
8513 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8514 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
8515 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
8516 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
8517 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
8518 coding;
8519 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
8520 regular UART 8N1) coding;
8521 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
8522 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
8523 data is to be output via SWO;
8524 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
8525 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
8526 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
8527 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
8528 rate automatically.
8529 @end itemize
8530
8531 Example usage:
8532 @enumerate
8533 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
8534 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
8535 enough to:
8536 @example
8537 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
8538 ...
8539 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
8540 ...
8541 @end example
8542 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
8543 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
8544 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
8545 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
8546 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
8547 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
8548 @example
8549 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
8550 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
8551 @end example
8552 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
8553 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
8554 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
8555 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
8556 @example
8557 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
8558 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
8559 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
8560 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
8561 @end example
8562 @end enumerate
8563 @end deffn
8564
8565 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8566 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
8567 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
8568 @end deffn
8569
8570 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8571 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
8572 @end deffn
8573
8574 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
8575 @cindex Cortex-M
8576
8577 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8578 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
8579
8580 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
8581 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
8582 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
8583 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
8584 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
8585 the step command leaves with the core running.
8586
8587 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
8588 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
8589 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
8590
8591 Default is @option{auto}.
8592 @end deffn
8593
8594 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8595 @cindex vector_catch
8596 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8597 for certain hardware events.
8598
8599 Parameters request interception of
8600 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
8601 @option{none} of them,
8602 or one or more of the following:
8603 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
8604 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
8605 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
8606 @option{irq_err},
8607 @option{state_err},
8608 @option{chk_err}, or
8609 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
8610 @option{reset}.
8611 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
8612 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
8613 are mapped to HardFault.
8614 UsageFault checks for
8615 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
8616 must also be explicitly enabled.
8617
8618 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
8619 @end deffn
8620
8621 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
8622 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
8623 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8624 @itemize @minus
8625 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8626 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
8627 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
8628 @end itemize
8629 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
8630 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
8631 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
8632 the peripherals.
8633 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
8634 @end deffn
8635
8636 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
8637 @cindex ARMv8-A
8638 @cindex aarch64
8639
8640 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
8641 Display information about target caches
8642 @end deffn
8643
8644 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
8645 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
8646 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
8647 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
8648 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
8649 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
8650 @end deffn
8651
8652 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp_on|smp_off}
8653 Enable and disable SMP handling. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
8654 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
8655 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
8656 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
8657 @end deffn
8658
8659 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8660 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
8661 @option{on}.
8662 @end deffn
8663
8664 @section Intel Architecture
8665
8666 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
8667 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
8668 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
8669 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
8670 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
8671 @itemize
8672 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
8673 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
8674 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
8675 @end itemize
8676
8677 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
8678 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
8679 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
8680
8681 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
8682 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8683 @end deffn
8684
8685 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
8686 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8687 @end deffn
8688
8689 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
8690 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8691 @end deffn
8692
8693 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
8694 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8695 @end deffn
8696
8697 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
8698 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8699 @end deffn
8700
8701 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
8702 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8703 @end deffn
8704
8705 @section OpenRISC Architecture
8706
8707 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
8708 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
8709
8710 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
8711 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
8712 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
8713 @end deffn
8714 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
8715 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
8716
8717 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
8718
8719 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
8720 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
8721 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
8722 @end deffn
8723
8724 @subsection Registers commands
8725 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
8726 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
8727 included in the generated target descriptor file.
8728
8729 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
8730
8731 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
8732 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
8733 and "timer" groups.
8734
8735 @emph{example:}
8736 @example
8737 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
8738 @end example
8739
8740
8741 @end deffn
8742 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
8743 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
8744
8745 @emph{group} can be "system",
8746 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
8747 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
8748 @end deffn
8749
8750 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
8751 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
8752 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
8753 @cindex tracing
8754 @cindex libdcc
8755 @cindex DCC
8756 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
8757 the target uses appropriate libraries.
8758 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
8759 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
8760
8761 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
8762 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
8763 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
8764 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
8765 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
8766 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
8767
8768 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
8769 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
8770 arrays of various size integers from the target,
8771 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
8772 The target being debugged may
8773 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
8774 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
8775 each supported by a command:
8776
8777 @itemize
8778 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
8779 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
8780 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
8781 finding out how some fault was triggered.
8782
8783 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
8784 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
8785 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
8786
8787 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
8788 and then displayed at any time.
8789 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
8790
8791 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
8792 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
8793 @end itemize
8794
8795 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
8796 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
8797 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
8798 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
8799 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
8800 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
8801 does the same thing.
8802
8803 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
8804 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
8805 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
8806 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
8807 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
8808
8809 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
8810 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
8811 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
8812 @end deffn
8813
8814 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
8815 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
8816 in the order they triggered.
8817 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
8818 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
8819 history records.
8820 @end deffn
8821
8822 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
8823 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
8824 they have been triggered.
8825 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
8826 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
8827 and associates it with that identifier.
8828
8829 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
8830 are not related except by this command.
8831 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
8832 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
8833 @end deffn
8834
8835
8836 @node JTAG Commands
8837 @chapter JTAG Commands
8838 @cindex JTAG Commands
8839 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
8840 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
8841 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
8842 may be needed to work with targets which require special
8843 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
8844
8845 To use these commands you will need to understand some
8846 of the basics of JTAG, including:
8847
8848 @itemize @bullet
8849 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
8850 devices such as a CPUs.
8851 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
8852 standard state machine (in parallel)
8853 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
8854 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
8855 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
8856 while the reading previous ones.
8857 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
8858 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
8859 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
8860 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
8861 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
8862 registers.
8863 @end itemize
8864
8865 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
8866
8867 These commands are used by developers who need to access
8868 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
8869 the order of TAP state transitions.
8870 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
8871 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
8872 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
8873 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
8874 these commands are not available.
8875
8876 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8877 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
8878 that specify the entire register.
8879 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
8880 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
8881 The return value holds the original value of each
8882 of those fields.
8883
8884 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
8885 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
8886 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
8887 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
8888 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
8889
8890 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
8891 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
8892
8893 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8894 in that state.
8895 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
8896 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8897 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8898
8899 @quotation Warning
8900 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
8901 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
8902 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
8903 data registers, which may have different lengths.
8904 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
8905 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
8906 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
8907 (by connecting a different scan chain).
8908 @end quotation
8909 @end deffn
8910
8911 @deffn Command {flush_count}
8912 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
8913 This may be used for performance tuning.
8914
8915 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
8916 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
8917 not change with the amount of data which is written.
8918 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
8919 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
8920 instead of batching them into larger operations.
8921 @end deffn
8922
8923 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8924 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
8925 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
8926 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
8927 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
8928 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
8929
8930 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8931 in that state.
8932 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
8933 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8934 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8935
8936 @quotation Note
8937 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
8938 register values, unlike data register values.
8939 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
8940 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
8941 @end quotation
8942 @end deffn
8943
8944 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
8945 Set values of reset signals.
8946 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
8947 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
8948 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
8949 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8950 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
8951 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8952 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8953
8954 Note that TRST is specially handled.
8955 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8956 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8957 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8958 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8959 instead of the TRST signal.
8960 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8961 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8962 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8963 with handlers for that event.
8964 @end deffn
8965
8966 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
8967 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
8968 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
8969 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
8970 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
8971 Then, in a series of single state transitions
8972 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
8973 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
8974 The final state must also be stable.
8975 @end deffn
8976
8977 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
8978 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
8979 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
8980 Instructions often need some time
8981 to execute before they take effect.
8982 @end deffn
8983
8984 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
8985 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
8986
8987 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8988 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
8989 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
8990 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
8991 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
8992 @end deffn
8993
8994 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8995 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
8996 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
8997 must also be enabled.
8998 Default is enabled.
8999 @end deffn
9000
9001 @section TAP state names
9002 @cindex TAP state names
9003
9004 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
9005 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
9006 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
9007 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
9008
9009 @itemize @bullet
9010 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
9011 acts as if TRST were pulsed
9012 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
9013 @item @b{DRSELECT}
9014 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
9015 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9016 through the data register
9017 @item @b{DREXIT1}
9018 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
9019 for update or more shifting
9020 @item @b{DREXIT2}
9021 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
9022 @item @b{IRSELECT}
9023 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
9024 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9025 through the instruction register
9026 @item @b{IREXIT1}
9027 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
9028 for update or more shifting
9029 @item @b{IREXIT2}
9030 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
9031 @end itemize
9032
9033 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
9034 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
9035 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
9036 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
9037
9038 @itemize @bullet
9039 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
9040 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
9041 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
9042 may not be as expected.
9043 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
9044 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
9045 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
9046 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
9047 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
9048 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
9049 @end itemize
9050
9051 @node Boundary Scan Commands
9052 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
9053
9054 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
9055 boundary scan based hardware testing.
9056 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
9057 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
9058
9059 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
9060 @cindex Serial Vector Format
9061 @cindex SVF
9062
9063 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
9064 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
9065 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9066 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9067
9068 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
9069 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
9070 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9071 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
9072
9073 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
9074 affect their semantics.
9075
9076 Command options:
9077 @itemize @minus
9078 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
9079 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
9080 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
9081 chain configuration, targetting @var{tapname};
9082 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
9083 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
9084 on the real interface;
9085 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
9086 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
9087 errors.
9088 @end itemize
9089 @end deffn
9090
9091 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9092 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9093 @cindex XSVF
9094
9095 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
9096 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
9097 Xilinx devices.
9098 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9099 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9100
9101 @quotation Important
9102 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
9103 @end quotation
9104
9105 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
9106 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9107 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
9108 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
9109 that TAP.
9110 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
9111 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
9112 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
9113 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
9114 @end deffn
9115
9116 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
9117 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
9118 after building the software.
9119 You may find them useful:
9120
9121 @itemize
9122 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
9123 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
9124 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
9125 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
9126 @end itemize
9127
9128 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
9129 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
9130 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
9131 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
9132 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
9133 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
9134 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
9135
9136
9137 @node Utility Commands
9138 @chapter Utility Commands
9139 @cindex Utility Commands
9140
9141 @section RAM testing
9142 @cindex RAM testing
9143
9144 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
9145 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
9146 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
9147 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
9148 hardware problems.
9149
9150 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
9151 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
9152 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
9153 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
9154
9155 Load the memory testing functions with
9156
9157 @example
9158 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
9159 @end example
9160
9161 to get access to the following facilities:
9162
9163 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
9164 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
9165 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
9166 @end deffn
9167
9168 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
9169 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
9170 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
9171 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
9172 @end deffn
9173
9174 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
9175 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
9176 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
9177 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
9178 @end deffn
9179
9180 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
9181 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
9182 @end deffn
9183
9184 @section Firmware recovery helpers
9185 @cindex Firmware recovery
9186
9187 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
9188 devices recovery with JTAG.
9189
9190 For quickstart instructions run:
9191 @example
9192 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
9193 @end example
9194
9195 @node TFTP
9196 @chapter TFTP
9197 @cindex TFTP
9198 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
9199 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
9200
9201 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
9202 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
9203 server (tftpd). For example,
9204
9205 @example
9206 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
9207 @end example
9208
9209 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
9210 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
9211
9212 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
9213 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
9214 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
9215 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
9216
9217 @node GDB and OpenOCD
9218 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
9219 @cindex GDB
9220 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
9221 to debug remote targets.
9222 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
9223
9224 @itemize
9225 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
9226 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
9227 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
9228 as shown in this chapter.
9229 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
9230 that also will probably need to be configured.
9231 @end itemize
9232
9233 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
9234 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
9235 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
9236 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
9237 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
9238 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
9239
9240 @section Connecting to GDB
9241 @cindex Connecting to GDB
9242 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
9243 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
9244 errors, which has since been fixed; see
9245 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
9246
9247 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
9248
9249 @enumerate
9250 @item
9251 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
9252 @example
9253 target remote localhost:3333
9254 @end example
9255 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
9256
9257 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
9258 @example
9259 target extended-remote localhost:3333
9260 @end example
9261 @item
9262 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
9263 @example
9264 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
9265 @end example
9266 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
9267 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
9268 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
9269 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
9270 @end enumerate
9271
9272 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
9273 GDB command line.
9274
9275 @section Sample GDB session startup
9276
9277 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
9278 than they do when you're debugging locally.
9279 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
9280 small ARM program.
9281 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
9282 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
9283
9284 @example
9285 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
9286 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
9287 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
9288 ...
9289 (gdb) monitor reset halt
9290 ...
9291 (gdb) load
9292 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
9293 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
9294 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
9295 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
9296 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
9297 (gdb) continue
9298 Continuing.
9299 ...
9300 @end example
9301
9302 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
9303 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
9304 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
9305 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
9306
9307 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
9308
9309 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
9310 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
9311 packet size and the device's memory map.
9312 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
9313 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
9314 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
9315
9316 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
9317 You may need to set those up by hand.
9318 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
9319 something like:
9320
9321 @example
9322 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
9323 @end example
9324
9325 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
9326
9327 @example
9328 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
9329 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
9330 @end example
9331
9332 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
9333 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
9334 do not have such restrictions.
9335
9336 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
9337 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
9338 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
9339 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
9340
9341 @section Programming using GDB
9342 @cindex Programming using GDB
9343 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
9344
9345 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
9346 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
9347 @example
9348 gdb_memory_map disable
9349 @end example
9350 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
9351 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
9352 working area.
9353
9354 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
9355 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
9356 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
9357 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
9358
9359 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
9360 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
9361
9362 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
9363 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
9364 @example
9365 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
9366 @end example
9367
9368 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
9369 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
9370
9371 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
9372 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
9373 will be used.
9374
9375 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
9376 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
9377 @example
9378 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
9379 @end example
9380 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
9381
9382 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
9383 can be used.
9384
9385 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
9386 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
9387 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
9388
9389 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
9390 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
9391 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
9392
9393 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
9394 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
9395 and GDB treats it as it were running.
9396 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
9397 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
9398 without any intrusion of the target process.
9399
9400 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9401 Place following command after target configuration:
9402 @example
9403 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
9404 @end example
9405
9406 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
9407 switch off gdb_memory_map:
9408 @example
9409 gdb_memory_map disable
9410 @end example
9411
9412 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
9413 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
9414 @example
9415 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
9416 @end example
9417
9418 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
9419 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
9420
9421 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target remote ...} and inspect memory
9422 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
9423 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
9424 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
9425
9426 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
9427 previously shown varibles.
9428
9429 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
9430 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
9431 @cindex SMP
9432 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
9433 @itemize @bullet
9434 @item j - smp status request
9435 @item J - smp set request
9436 @end itemize
9437
9438 OpenOCD implements :
9439 @itemize @bullet
9440 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
9441 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
9442 @option{E01} for target not smp.
9443 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
9444 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
9445 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
9446 @end itemize
9447
9448 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
9449 @itemize @bullet
9450 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
9451 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
9452 @example
9453 set $_core 1
9454 #Jc01 packet is sent
9455 print $_core
9456 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
9457 @end example
9458
9459 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
9460 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
9461
9462 @example
9463 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
9464 define toggle0
9465 maint packet Jc0
9466 continue
9467 main packet Jc-1
9468 end
9469 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
9470 define toggle1
9471 maint packet Jc1
9472 continue
9473 main packet Jc-1
9474 end
9475 @end example
9476 @end itemize
9477
9478 @section RTOS Support
9479 @cindex RTOS Support
9480 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
9481
9482 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
9483 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
9484
9485 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
9486 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
9487 GDB commands.
9488
9489 @* An example setup is below:
9490
9491 @example
9492 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
9493 @end example
9494
9495 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
9496
9497 Currently supported rtos's include:
9498 @itemize @bullet
9499 @item @option{eCos}
9500 @item @option{ThreadX}
9501 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
9502 @item @option{linux}
9503 @item @option{ChibiOS}
9504 @item @option{embKernel}
9505 @item @option{mqx}
9506 @item @option{uCOS-III}
9507 @end itemize
9508
9509 @quotation Note
9510 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
9511 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
9512 @end quotation
9513
9514 @table @code
9515 @item eCos symbols
9516 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
9517 @item ThreadX symbols
9518 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
9519 @item FreeRTOS symbols
9520 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
9521 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
9522 @tex
9523 \begingroup
9524 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
9525 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
9526 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
9527 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
9528 \par
9529 \endgroup
9530 @end tex
9531 @item linux symbols
9532 init_task.
9533 @item ChibiOS symbols
9534 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
9535 @item embKernel symbols
9536 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
9537 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
9538 @item mqx symbols
9539 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
9540 @item uC/OS-III symbols
9541 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
9542 @end table
9543
9544 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
9545 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
9546
9547 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
9548 along with the project:
9549
9550 @table @code
9551 @item FreeRTOS
9552 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
9553 @item uC/OS-III
9554 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
9555 @end table
9556
9557 @node Tcl Scripting API
9558 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
9559 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
9560 @cindex Tcl scripts
9561 @section API rules
9562
9563 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
9564 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
9565 of state information as an argument to each proc.
9566
9567 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
9568 pair list and lists.
9569
9570 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
9571 list.
9572
9573 @example
9574 > set foo(me) Duane
9575 > set foo(you) Oyvind
9576 > set foo(mouse) Micky
9577 > set foo(duck) Donald
9578 @end example
9579
9580 If one does this:
9581
9582 @example
9583 > set foo
9584 @end example
9585
9586 The result is:
9587
9588 @example
9589 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
9590 @end example
9591
9592 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
9593
9594 @verbatim
9595 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
9596 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
9597 }
9598 @end verbatim
9599
9600 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
9601 should be passed in to the proc in question.
9602
9603 @section Internal low-level Commands
9604
9605 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
9606 invoke directly.
9607
9608 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
9609 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
9610 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
9611
9612 @itemize @bullet
9613 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
9614
9615 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
9616 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
9617
9618 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
9619 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
9620
9621 Return information about the flash banks
9622
9623 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
9624
9625 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
9626 its execution. Example:
9627
9628 @example
9629 > capture "reset init"
9630 @end example
9631
9632 @end itemize
9633
9634 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
9635 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
9636 called "flash_banks".
9637
9638 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
9639
9640 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
9641 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
9642 holds one of the following values:
9643
9644 @itemize @bullet
9645 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
9646 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
9647 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
9648 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
9649 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
9650 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
9651 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
9652 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
9653 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
9654 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
9655 @end itemize
9656
9657 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
9658
9659 @quotation Note
9660 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
9661 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
9662 @code{jim_platform} (because it
9663 is jim, not real tcl).
9664 @end quotation
9665
9666 @section Tcl RPC server
9667 @cindex RPC
9668
9669 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
9670 commands and receive the results.
9671
9672 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
9673 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
9674 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
9675 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
9676 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
9677
9678 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
9679 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
9680 @command{capture} command.
9681
9682 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
9683
9684 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
9685 @cindex RPC Notifications
9686
9687 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9688 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9689
9690 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
9691 in the following format.
9692
9693 @verbatim
9694 type target_event event [event-name]
9695 type target_state state [state-name]
9696 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
9697 @end verbatim
9698
9699 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
9700 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
9701 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9702 Defaults to off.
9703
9704 @end deffn
9705
9706 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
9707 @cindex RPC trace output
9708
9709 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9710 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9711
9712 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
9713
9714 @verbatim
9715 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
9716 @end verbatim
9717
9718 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
9719 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
9720 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9721 Defaults to off.
9722
9723 See an example application here:
9724 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
9725
9726 @end deffn
9727
9728 @node FAQ
9729 @chapter FAQ
9730 @cindex faq
9731 @enumerate
9732 @anchor{faqrtck}
9733 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
9734 @cindex RTCK
9735 @cindex adaptive clocking
9736 @*
9737
9738 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
9739 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
9740 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
9741 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
9742
9743 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
9744 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
9745 for example. There are 2 basic options:
9746 @enumerate
9747 @item
9748 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
9749 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
9750 @item
9751 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
9752 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
9753 @end enumerate
9754
9755 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
9756 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
9757 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
9758 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
9759 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
9760 power).
9761
9762 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
9763 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
9764 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
9765 ARM926 scenario).
9766 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
9767 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
9768 JTAG can use a faster clock.
9769
9770 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
9771 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
9772 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
9773 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
9774
9775 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
9776
9777 In order to make use of this,
9778 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
9779 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
9780
9781 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
9782 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
9783 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
9784 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
9785 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
9786
9787 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
9788 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
9789 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
9790 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
9791
9792 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
9793 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
9794 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
9795 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
9796 with a CPLD.
9797 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
9798 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
9799 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
9800 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
9801 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
9802 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
9803
9804 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
9805
9806 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
9807
9808 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
9809 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
9810 depending on the chips on your board.
9811 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
9812 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
9813 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
9814
9815 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
9816 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
9817 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
9818
9819 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
9820 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
9821 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
9822 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
9823
9824 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
9825 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
9826 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
9827 this way.
9828
9829 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
9830 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
9831 clock rate.
9832 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
9833 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
9834 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
9835
9836 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
9837
9838 @example
9839 # Example: 1.234MHz
9840 adapter_khz 1234
9841 @end example
9842
9843
9844 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
9845
9846 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
9847 around Windows filenames.
9848
9849 @example
9850 > echo \a
9851
9852 > echo @{\a@}
9853 \a
9854 > echo "\a"
9855
9856 >
9857 @end example
9858
9859
9860 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
9861
9862 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
9863 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
9864 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
9865
9866 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
9867 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
9868 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
9869
9870 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
9871 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
9872 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
9873
9874 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
9875
9876 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
9877 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
9878 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
9879 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
9880
9881 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
9882 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
9883 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
9884
9885 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
9886 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
9887
9888 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
9889 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
9890 memory read caused data abort".
9891
9892 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
9893 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
9894 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
9895 be done, feel free to add this here.
9896
9897 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
9898 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
9899 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
9900 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
9901 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
9902 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
9903 gracefully stops.
9904
9905 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
9906 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
9907 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
9908
9909 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
9910 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
9911 bytes. Painful...
9912
9913
9914 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
9915 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
9916
9917 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
9918 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
9919 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
9920 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
9921 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
9922 reset, everything else should work fine.
9923
9924 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
9925 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
9926 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
9927 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
9928
9929 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
9930 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
9931 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
9932 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
9933
9934 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
9935
9936 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
9937 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
9938 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9939
9940 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
9941 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
9942
9943 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
9944 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
9945 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
9946 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
9947 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
9948 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
9949 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
9950 clock frequency?
9951
9952 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
9953 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
9954 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
9955 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
9956 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
9957
9958 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
9959
9960 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
9961 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
9962 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
9963 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
9964 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
9965 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
9966 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
9967
9968 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
9969
9970 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
9971 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
9972 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
9973 up DRAM and loading it with code.
9974
9975 @anchor{faqtaporder}
9976 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
9977 particular order?
9978
9979 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
9980 the same order used by the hardware.
9981
9982 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
9983 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
9984 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
9985 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
9986 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
9987 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
9988
9989 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
9990 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
9991 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
9992 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
9993
9994 @itemize @bullet
9995 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
9996 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
9997 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
9998 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
9999 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
10000 @end itemize
10001
10002 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
10003
10004 @itemize @bullet
10005 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
10006 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
10007 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
10008 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
10009 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
10010 @end itemize
10011
10012
10013 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
10014 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
10015 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
10016
10017 TODO.
10018
10019 @end enumerate
10020
10021 @node Tcl Crash Course
10022 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
10023 @cindex Tcl
10024
10025 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
10026 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
10027 how the Tcl scripts work.
10028
10029 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
10030 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
10031 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
10032 OpenOCD.
10033
10034 @section Tcl Rule #1
10035 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
10036 @enumerate
10037 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
10038 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10039 @end enumerate
10040
10041 The Tcl equal is this:
10042
10043 @enumerate
10044 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
10045 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10046 @end enumerate
10047
10048 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
10049 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
10050
10051 @section Tcl Rule #1b
10052 There is a second pair of rules.
10053 @enumerate
10054 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
10055 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
10056 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
10057 in Tcl.
10058 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10059 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
10060 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
10061 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
10062 @end enumerate
10063
10064 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
10065 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
10066 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
10067 Everything is a string}
10068
10069 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
10070 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
10071 difference is subtle.
10072 @enumerate
10073 @item Parse Time
10074 @item Evaluation Time
10075 @end enumerate
10076
10077 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
10078 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
10079 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
10080
10081 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
10082 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
10083 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
10084 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
10085
10086 @itemize @bullet
10087 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
10088 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
10089 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
10090 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
10091 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
10092 @example
10093 # bash example
10094 X=`date`
10095 echo "The Date is: $X"
10096 # Tcl example
10097 set X [date]
10098 puts "The Date is: $X"
10099 @end example
10100 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
10101 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
10102 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
10103 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
10104 is a string}
10105 @example
10106 set x "Dinner"
10107 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
10108 @end example
10109 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
10110 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
10111 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
10112 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
10113 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
10114 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
10115 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
10116 @end itemize
10117
10118 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
10119
10120 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
10121
10122 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
10123
10124 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
10125 the normal way.
10126
10127 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
10128 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
10129 line is immedatly executed.
10130
10131 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
10132 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
10133
10134 @subsection Command Execution
10135
10136 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
10137 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
10138 control flow operators.
10139
10140 Commands are executed like this:
10141
10142 @enumerate
10143 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
10144 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
10145 @item Repeat until End Of File.
10146 @end enumerate
10147
10148 It sort of works like this:
10149 @example
10150 for(;;)@{
10151 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
10152
10153 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
10154
10155 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
10156 @}
10157 @end example
10158
10159 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
10160 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
10161 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
10162 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
10163 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
10164 ``LookupCommand()''
10165
10166 @subsection The FOR command
10167
10168 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
10169 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
10170 command just like any other command.
10171
10172 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
10173 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
10174 are:
10175
10176 @enumerate 0
10177 @item The ascii text 'for'
10178 @item The start text
10179 @item The test expression
10180 @item The next text
10181 @item The body text
10182 @end enumerate
10183
10184 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
10185 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
10186 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
10187 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
10188
10189 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
10190 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
10191
10192 @example
10193 int
10194 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
10195 int *argc,
10196 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
10197 @end example
10198
10199 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
10200 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
10201 still operates in the same basic way.
10202
10203 @subsection FOR command implementation
10204
10205 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
10206 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
10207
10208 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
10209
10210 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
10211
10212 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
10213 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
10214 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
10215
10216 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
10217 expression and returns a value.
10218
10219 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
10220 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
10221 @example
10222 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
10223
10224 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
10225
10226 int
10227 MyForCommand( void *interp,
10228 int argc,
10229 char **argv )
10230 @{
10231 if( argc != 5 )@{
10232 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
10233 return ERROR;
10234 @}
10235
10236 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
10237
10238 // Execute the start statement.
10239 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
10240
10241 // Top of loop test
10242 for(;;)@{
10243 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
10244 if( i == 0 )
10245 break;
10246
10247 // Execute the body
10248 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
10249
10250 // Execute the LOOP part
10251 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
10252 @}
10253
10254 // Return no error
10255 SetResult( interp, "" );
10256 return SUCCESS;
10257 @}
10258 @end example
10259
10260 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
10261 in the same basic way.
10262
10263 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
10264
10265 @subsection source and find commands
10266 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
10267 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
10268 @*Remember the parsing rules
10269 @enumerate
10270 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
10271 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
10272 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
10273 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
10274 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
10275 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
10276 That character begins Tcl comments.)
10277 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
10278 it reads a file and executes as a script.
10279 @end enumerate
10280 @subsection format command
10281 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
10282 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
10283 @b{sprintf()}.
10284 @b{Example}
10285 @example
10286 set x 6
10287 set y 7
10288 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
10289 @end example
10290 @enumerate
10291 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
10292 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
10293 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
10294 @* Refer to Rule #1
10295 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
10296 @* Refer to Rule #1.
10297 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
10298 @end enumerate
10299 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
10300 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
10301 @example
10302 #1 Good
10303 proc someproc @{@} @{
10304 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
10305 @}
10306 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
10307 #2 Good - no variables
10308 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
10309 #3 Good Curly Braces
10310 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
10311 puts "Time: [date]"
10312 @}
10313 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
10314 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
10315 @end example
10316 @enumerate
10317 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
10318 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
10319 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
10320 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
10321 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
10322 command.
10323 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
10324 @*There are 4 examples:
10325 @enumerate
10326 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
10327 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
10328 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
10329 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
10330 @end enumerate
10331
10332 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
10333 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
10334 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
10335
10336 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
10337 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
10338 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
10339 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
10340 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
10341 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
10342 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
10343 @end enumerate
10344 @subsection Global Variables
10345 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
10346 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
10347 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
10348 @example
10349 proc myproc @{ @} @{
10350 set y 0 #Local variable Y
10351 global x #Global variable X
10352 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
10353 @}
10354 @end example
10355 @section Other Tcl Hacks
10356 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
10357 @example
10358 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
10359 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
10360 # Create var name
10361 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
10362 # Make it a global
10363 global $vn
10364 # Set it.
10365 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
10366 @}
10367 @end example
10368 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
10369 @example
10370 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
10371 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
10372 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
10373 @}
10374 @end example
10375
10376 @include fdl.texi
10377
10378 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
10379 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
10380 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
10381 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
10382 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
10383 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
10384
10385 @printindex cp
10386
10387 @node Command and Driver Index
10388 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
10389 @printindex fn
10390
10391 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)